1 //===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 //  This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13 
14 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
15 #include "CXXABI.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
29 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
30 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
31 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
32 #include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
33 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
34 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
35 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
37 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
38 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
39 #include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
40 #include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
41 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
42 #include <map>
43 
44 using namespace clang;
45 
46 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
48 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
50 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
52 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
54 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
56 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58 
59 enum FloatingRank {
60   HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
61 };
62 
63 RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
64   if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65     ExternalSource->ReadComments();
66 
67 #ifndef NDEBUG
68     ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69     assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70                           BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71 #endif
72 
73     CommentsLoaded = true;
74   }
75 
76   assert(D);
77 
78   // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79   if (D->isImplicit())
80     return nullptr;
81 
82   // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
85       return nullptr;
86   }
87 
88   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90         VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
91       return nullptr;
92   }
93 
94   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95     if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
96       return nullptr;
97   }
98 
99   if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100           dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101     TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102     if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103         TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
104       return nullptr;
105   }
106 
107   if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108     if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
109       return nullptr;
110   }
111   if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112     // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113     // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114     if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
115       return nullptr;
116   }
117   // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118   if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
119     return nullptr;
120 
121   // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122   // documentation.
123   if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124       isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125       isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
126     return nullptr;
127 
128   ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
129 
130   // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131   if (RawComments.empty())
132     return nullptr;
133 
134   // Find declaration location.
135   // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136   // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137   // location".
138   // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139   // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140   SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141   if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
142       isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
143       isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144       isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
145     DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
146   else {
147     DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
148     if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149       if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150         // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151         // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152         // the "declaration location".
153         DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154       } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155         // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156         // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157         // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl.  In that
158         // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159         // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160         if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161             TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162           DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163       }
164     }
165   }
166 
167   // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168   // can't find the comment.
169   if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
170     return nullptr;
171 
172   // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
173   ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174   {
175     // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176     // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177     // first.
178     RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179         SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180         LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
181     BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182     ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183     bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184     if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185       MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186       Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187     }
188 
189     if (Found) {
190       Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191       assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192                                          &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193     } else {
194       // Slow path.
195       Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196                                  &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197     }
198   }
199 
200   // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201   // file buffer.
202   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203 
204   // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205   if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
206       (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
207       (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
208        isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
209     std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
210       = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
211     // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212     // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213     if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214         SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215           == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216                                      CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
217       return *Comment;
218     }
219   }
220 
221   // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222   // Let's look at the previous comment.
223   if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
224     return nullptr;
225   --Comment;
226 
227   // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
228   if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
229     return nullptr;
230 
231   // Decompose the end of the comment.
232   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
233     = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
234 
235   // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236   // aren't related.
237   if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
238     return nullptr;
239 
240   // Get the corresponding buffer.
241   bool Invalid = false;
242   const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243                                                &Invalid).data();
244   if (Invalid)
245     return nullptr;
246 
247   // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248   StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249                  DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250 
251   // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252   // comment and declaration.
253   if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
254     return nullptr;
255 
256   return *Comment;
257 }
258 
259 namespace {
260 /// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261 /// refer to the actual template.
262 /// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
263 const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
264   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
265     // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
266     if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
267       return FTD;
268 
269     // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271       return D;
272 
273     // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274     if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275       return FTD;
276 
277     // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278     if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279             FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280       return MemberDecl;
281 
282     return D;
283   }
284   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285     // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286     // template?
287     if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288       if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289         return MemberDecl;
290 
291     return D;
292   }
293   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294     // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295     if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296       return CTD;
297 
298     // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299     // specialization?
300     if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301             dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302       if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303         return D;
304       llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305                          ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306           PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307       return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308           static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309           static_cast<const Decl*>(
310               PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311     }
312 
313     // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314     if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315                    CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316       return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317 
318     return D;
319   }
320   if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321     // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322     if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323       return MemberDecl;
324 
325     return D;
326   }
327   // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
328   return D;
329 }
330 } // unnamed namespace
331 
332 const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333                                                 const Decl *D,
334                                                 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
335   D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
336 
337   // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338   {
339     llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340         RedeclComments.find(D);
341     if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342       const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
343       if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344         if (OriginalDecl)
345           *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
346         return Raw.getRaw();
347       }
348     }
349   }
350 
351   // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
352   const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353   const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
354   for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
355     llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
356         RedeclComments.find(I);
357     if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358       const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359       if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360         RC = Raw.getRaw();
361         OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
362         break;
363       }
364     } else {
365       RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366       OriginalDeclForRC = I;
367       RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368       if (RC) {
369         Raw.setRaw(RC);
370         Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
371       } else
372         Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
373       Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
374       RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
375       if (RC)
376         break;
377     }
378   }
379 
380   // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
381   assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
382 
383   if (OriginalDecl)
384     *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
385 
386   // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
387   RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
388   Raw.setRaw(RC);
389   Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
390   Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
391 
392   for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
393     RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
394     if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
395       R = Raw;
396   }
397 
398   return RC;
399 }
400 
401 static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
402                    SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
403   const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
404   if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
405     const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
406     if (!ID)
407       return;
408     // Add redeclared method here.
409     for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
410       if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
411             Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
412                                   ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
413         Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
414     }
415   }
416 }
417 
418 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
419                                                     const Decl *D) const {
420   comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
421   ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
422   ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
423   ThisDeclInfo->fill();
424   ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
425   if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
426     ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
427   comments::FullComment *CFC =
428     new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
429                                       ThisDeclInfo);
430   return CFC;
431 
432 }
433 
434 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
435   const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
436   return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
437 }
438 
439 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
440                                               const Decl *D,
441                                               const Preprocessor *PP) const {
442   if (D->isInvalidDecl())
443     return nullptr;
444   D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
445 
446   const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
447   llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
448       ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
449 
450   if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
451     if (Canonical != D) {
452       comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
453       comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
454       return CFC;
455     }
456     return Pos->second;
457   }
458 
459   const Decl *OriginalDecl;
460 
461   const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
462   if (!RC) {
463     if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
464       SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
465       const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
466       if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
467         if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
468           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
469             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
470       if (OMD)
471         addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
472       getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
473       for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
474         if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
475           return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
476     }
477     else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
478       // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
479       // does not have one of its own.
480       QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
481       if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
482         if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
483           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
484             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
485     }
486     else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
487       while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
488         IC = IC->getSuperClass();
489         if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
490           return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
491       }
492     }
493     else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
494       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
495         if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
496           return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
497     }
498     else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
499       if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
500         return nullptr;
501       // Check non-virtual bases.
502       for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
503         if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
504           continue;
505         QualType Ty = I.getType();
506         if (Ty.isNull())
507           continue;
508         if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509           if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510             continue;
511 
512           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
513             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
514         }
515       }
516       // Check virtual bases.
517       for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
518         if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
519           continue;
520         QualType Ty = I.getType();
521         if (Ty.isNull())
522           continue;
523         if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
524           if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
525             continue;
526           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
527             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
528         }
529       }
530     }
531     return nullptr;
532   }
533 
534   // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
535   // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl.  This is important
536   // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
537   // different across redeclarations.
538   if (D != OriginalDecl)
539     return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
540 
541   comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
542   ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
543   return FC;
544 }
545 
546 void
547 ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
548                                                TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
549   ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
550   ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
551   ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
552 
553   TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
554   ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
555   for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
556                                           PEnd = Params->end();
557        P != PEnd; ++P) {
558     if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
559       ID.AddInteger(0);
560       ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
561       continue;
562     }
563 
564     if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
565       ID.AddInteger(1);
566       ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
567       ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
568       if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
569         ID.AddBoolean(true);
570         ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
571         for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
572           QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
573           ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
574         }
575       } else
576         ID.AddBoolean(false);
577       continue;
578     }
579 
580     TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
581     ID.AddInteger(2);
582     Profile(ID, TTP);
583   }
584 }
585 
586 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
587 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
588                                           TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
589   // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
590   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
591   CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
592   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
593   CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
594     = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
595   if (Canonical)
596     return Canonical->getParam();
597 
598   // Build a canonical template parameter list.
599   TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
600   SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
601   CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
602   for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
603                                           PEnd = Params->end();
604        P != PEnd; ++P) {
605     if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
606       CanonParams.push_back(
607                   TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
608                                                SourceLocation(),
609                                                SourceLocation(),
610                                                TTP->getDepth(),
611                                                TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
612                                                TTP->isParameterPack()));
613     else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
614              = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
615       QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
616       TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
617       NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
618       if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
619         SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
620         SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
621         for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
622           ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
623           ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
624                                 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
625         }
626 
627         Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
628                                                 SourceLocation(),
629                                                 SourceLocation(),
630                                                 NTTP->getDepth(),
631                                                 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
632                                                 T,
633                                                 TInfo,
634                                                 ExpandedTypes.data(),
635                                                 ExpandedTypes.size(),
636                                                 ExpandedTInfos.data());
637       } else {
638         Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
639                                                 SourceLocation(),
640                                                 SourceLocation(),
641                                                 NTTP->getDepth(),
642                                                 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
643                                                 T,
644                                                 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645                                                 TInfo);
646       }
647       CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648 
649     } else
650       CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651                                            cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652   }
653 
654   TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655     = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656                                        SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
657                                        TTP->getPosition(),
658                                        TTP->isParameterPack(),
659                                        nullptr,
660                          TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661                                                        SourceLocation(),
662                                                        CanonParams.data(),
663                                                        CanonParams.size(),
664                                                        SourceLocation()));
665 
666   // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
667   Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
668   assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
669   (void)Canonical;
670 
671   // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
672   Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
673   CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
674   return CanonTTP;
675 }
676 
677 CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
678   if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
679 
680   switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
681   case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
682   case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
683   case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
684   case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
685   case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
686   case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
687   case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
688     return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
689   case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
690     return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
691   }
692   llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
693 }
694 
695 static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
696                                              const LangOptions &LOpts) {
697   if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
698     // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
699     // language-specific address space.
700     static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
701       1, // opencl_global
702       2, // opencl_local
703       3, // opencl_constant
704       4, // opencl_generic
705       5, // cuda_device
706       6, // cuda_constant
707       7  // cuda_shared
708     };
709     return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
710   } else {
711     return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
712   }
713 }
714 
715 static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
716                                           const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
717   switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
718   case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
719     return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
720   case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
721     return true;
722   case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
723     return false;
724   }
725   llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
726 }
727 
728 ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
729                        IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
730                        Builtin::Context &builtins)
731     : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
732       DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
733       SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
734       GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
735       UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
736       BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr), BuiltinMSVaListDecl(nullptr),
737       ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr), ObjCClassDecl(nullptr),
738       ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
739       CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
740       FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
741       ucontext_tDecl(nullptr), BlockDescriptorType(nullptr),
742       BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr), cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
743       FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(), ExternCContext(nullptr),
744       SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
745       SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
746       AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
747       Idents(idents), Selectors(sels), BuiltinInfo(builtins),
748       DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr),
749       Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
750       CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
751   TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
752 }
753 
754 ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
755   ReleaseParentMapEntries();
756 
757   // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
758   // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
759   ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
760 
761   // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
762   for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
763            E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
764     for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
765       (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
766 
767   // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
768   // because they can contain DenseMaps.
769   for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
770        const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
771        I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
772     // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
773     if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
774       R->Destroy(*this);
775 
776   for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
777        I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
778     // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
779     if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
780       R->Destroy(*this);
781   }
782 
783   for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
784                                                     AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
785        A != AEnd; ++A)
786     A->second->~AttrVec();
787 
788   for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair :
789        MaterializedTemporaryValues)
790     MTVPair.second->~APValue();
791 
792   llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
793 }
794 
795 void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
796   if (!AllParents) return;
797   for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) {
798     if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
799       delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
800     } else {
801       assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>());
802       delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
803     }
804   }
805 }
806 
807 void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
808   Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
809 }
810 
811 void
812 ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
813   ExternalSource = Source;
814 }
815 
816 void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
817   llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
818   llvm::errs() << "  " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
819 
820   unsigned counts[] = {
821 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
822 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
823 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
824     0 // Extra
825   };
826 
827   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
828     Type *T = Types[i];
829     counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
830   }
831 
832   unsigned Idx = 0;
833   unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
834 #define TYPE(Name, Parent)                                              \
835   if (counts[Idx])                                                      \
836     llvm::errs() << "    " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name               \
837                  << " types\n";                                         \
838   TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type);                       \
839   ++Idx;
840 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
841 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
842 
843   llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
844 
845   // Implicit special member functions.
846   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
847                << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
848                << " implicit default constructors created\n";
849   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
850                << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
851                << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
852   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
853     llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
854                  << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
855                  << " implicit move constructors created\n";
856   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
857                << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
858                << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
859   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
860     llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
861                  << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
862                  << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
863   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
864                << NumImplicitDestructors
865                << " implicit destructors created\n";
866 
867   if (ExternalSource) {
868     llvm::errs() << "\n";
869     ExternalSource->PrintStats();
870   }
871 
872   BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
873 }
874 
875 void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
876                                            bool NotifyListeners) {
877   if (NotifyListeners)
878     if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
879       Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
880 
881   if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
882     MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
883   else
884     ND->setHidden(false);
885 }
886 
887 void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
888   auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
889   if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
890     return;
891 
892   auto &Merged = It->second;
893   llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
894   for (Module *&M : Merged)
895     if (!Found.insert(M).second)
896       M = nullptr;
897   Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
898 }
899 
900 ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
901   if (!ExternCContext)
902     ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
903 
904   return ExternCContext;
905 }
906 
907 RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
908                                             RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
909   SourceLocation Loc;
910   RecordDecl *NewDecl;
911   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
912     NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
913                                     Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
914   else
915     NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
916                                  &Idents.get(Name));
917   NewDecl->setImplicit();
918   NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
919       const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
920   return NewDecl;
921 }
922 
923 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
924                                               StringRef Name) const {
925   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
926   TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
927       const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
928       SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
929   NewDecl->setImplicit();
930   return NewDecl;
931 }
932 
933 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
934   if (!Int128Decl)
935     Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
936   return Int128Decl;
937 }
938 
939 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
940   if (!UInt128Decl)
941     UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
942   return UInt128Decl;
943 }
944 
945 TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
946   assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
947   if (!Float128StubDecl)
948     Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
949 
950   return Float128StubDecl;
951 }
952 
953 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
954   BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
955   R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
956   Types.push_back(Ty);
957 }
958 
959 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
960   assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
961          "Incorrect target reinitialization");
962   assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
963 
964   this->Target = &Target;
965 
966   ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
967   AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
968   AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
969 
970   // C99 6.2.5p19.
971   InitBuiltinType(VoidTy,              BuiltinType::Void);
972 
973   // C99 6.2.5p2.
974   InitBuiltinType(BoolTy,              BuiltinType::Bool);
975   // C99 6.2.5p3.
976   if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
977     InitBuiltinType(CharTy,            BuiltinType::Char_S);
978   else
979     InitBuiltinType(CharTy,            BuiltinType::Char_U);
980   // C99 6.2.5p4.
981   InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy,        BuiltinType::SChar);
982   InitBuiltinType(ShortTy,             BuiltinType::Short);
983   InitBuiltinType(IntTy,               BuiltinType::Int);
984   InitBuiltinType(LongTy,              BuiltinType::Long);
985   InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy,          BuiltinType::LongLong);
986 
987   // C99 6.2.5p6.
988   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy,      BuiltinType::UChar);
989   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy,     BuiltinType::UShort);
990   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy,       BuiltinType::UInt);
991   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy,      BuiltinType::ULong);
992   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy,  BuiltinType::ULongLong);
993 
994   // C99 6.2.5p10.
995   InitBuiltinType(FloatTy,             BuiltinType::Float);
996   InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy,            BuiltinType::Double);
997   InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy,        BuiltinType::LongDouble);
998 
999   // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1000   InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty,            BuiltinType::Int128);
1001   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty,    BuiltinType::UInt128);
1002 
1003   // C++ 3.9.1p5
1004   if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1005     InitBuiltinType(WCharTy,           BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1006   else  // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1007     InitBuiltinType(WCharTy,           BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1008   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1009     WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1010   else {
1011     // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1012     WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1013   }
1014 
1015   WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1016 
1017   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1018     InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty,           BuiltinType::Char16);
1019   else // C99
1020     Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1021 
1022   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1023     InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty,           BuiltinType::Char32);
1024   else // C99
1025     Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1026 
1027   // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1028   // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1029   // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1030   // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1031   // expressions.
1032   InitBuiltinType(DependentTy,         BuiltinType::Dependent);
1033 
1034   // Placeholder type for functions.
1035   InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy,          BuiltinType::Overload);
1036 
1037   // Placeholder type for bound members.
1038   InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy,       BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1039 
1040   // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1041   InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy,      BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1042 
1043   // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1044   InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy,        BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1045 
1046   // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1047   InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy,  BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1048 
1049   // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1050   InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy,  BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1051 
1052   // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1053   if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
1054     InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1055 
1056   // C99 6.2.5p11.
1057   FloatComplexTy      = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1058   DoubleComplexTy     = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1059   LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
1060 
1061   // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
1062   InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1063   InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
1064   InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
1065 
1066   if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1067     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1068     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1069     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1070     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1071     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1072     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dDepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth);
1073     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayDepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth);
1074     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dMSAATy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA);
1075     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayMSAATy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA);
1076     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dMSAADepthTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth);
1077     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepthTy,
1078                     BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth);
1079     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
1080 
1081     InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
1082     InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
1083     InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1084     InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
1085     InitBuiltinType(OCLNDRangeTy, BuiltinType::OCLNDRange);
1086     InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
1087   }
1088 
1089   // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
1090   ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1091                        SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
1092 
1093   ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
1094 
1095   ObjCSuperType = QualType();
1096 
1097   // void * type
1098   VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
1099 
1100   // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1101   InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy,           BuiltinType::NullPtr);
1102 
1103   // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1104   InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
1105 
1106   // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1107   VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
1108 }
1109 
1110 DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
1111   return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1112 }
1113 
1114 AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1115   AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1116   if (!Result) {
1117     void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1118     Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1119   }
1120 
1121   return *Result;
1122 }
1123 
1124 /// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1125 void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1126   llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1127   if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1128     Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1129     DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1130   }
1131 }
1132 
1133 // FIXME: Remove ?
1134 MemberSpecializationInfo *
1135 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
1136   assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1137   return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1138       .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1139 }
1140 
1141 ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1142 ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1143   llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1144       TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1145   if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1146     return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
1147 
1148   return Pos->second;
1149 }
1150 
1151 void
1152 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
1153                                                 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1154                                           SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
1155   assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1156   assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1157   setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1158                                             Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1159 }
1160 
1161 void
1162 ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1163                                             TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1164   assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1165          "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1166   TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
1167 }
1168 
1169 FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1170                                                      const FunctionDecl *FD){
1171   assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1172   llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
1173     = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1174   if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
1175     return nullptr;
1176 
1177   return Pos->second;
1178 }
1179 
1180 void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1181                                         FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1182   assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1183   assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
1184   ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
1185 }
1186 
1187 NamedDecl *
1188 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
1189   llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
1190     = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1191   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
1192     return nullptr;
1193 
1194   return Pos->second;
1195 }
1196 
1197 void
1198 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1199   assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1200           isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1201           isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1202          "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1203   assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1204   InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1205 }
1206 
1207 UsingShadowDecl *
1208 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1209   llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1210     = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1211   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
1212     return nullptr;
1213 
1214   return Pos->second;
1215 }
1216 
1217 void
1218 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1219                                                UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1220   assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1221   InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1222 }
1223 
1224 FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1225   llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1226     = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1227   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
1228     return nullptr;
1229 
1230   return Pos->second;
1231 }
1232 
1233 void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1234                                                      FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1235   assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1236   assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1237   assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1238          "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
1239 
1240   InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1241 }
1242 
1243 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1244 ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1245   llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
1246     = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1247   if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1248     return nullptr;
1249 
1250   return Pos->second.begin();
1251 }
1252 
1253 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1254 ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1255   llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
1256     = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1257   if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1258     return nullptr;
1259 
1260   return Pos->second.end();
1261 }
1262 
1263 unsigned
1264 ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1265   llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
1266     = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1267   if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1268     return 0;
1269 
1270   return Pos->second.size();
1271 }
1272 
1273 void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1274                                      const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
1275   assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
1276   OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1277 }
1278 
1279 void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1280                       const NamedDecl *D,
1281                       SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
1282   assert(D);
1283 
1284   if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
1285     Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1286                       overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
1287     return;
1288   }
1289 
1290   const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1291   if (!Method)
1292     return;
1293 
1294   SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1295   Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
1296   Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
1297 }
1298 
1299 void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1300   assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1301   assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1302   if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1303     FirstLocalImport = Import;
1304     LastLocalImport = Import;
1305     return;
1306   }
1307 
1308   LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1309   LastLocalImport = Import;
1310 }
1311 
1312 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1313 //                         Type Sizing and Analysis
1314 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1315 
1316 /// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1317 /// scalar floating point type.
1318 const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
1319   const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
1320   assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1321   switch (BT->getKind()) {
1322   default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
1323   case BuiltinType::Half:       return Target->getHalfFormat();
1324   case BuiltinType::Float:      return Target->getFloatFormat();
1325   case BuiltinType::Double:     return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1326   case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
1327   }
1328 }
1329 
1330 CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
1331   unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
1332 
1333   bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1334   if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1335     Align = AlignFromAttr;
1336 
1337     // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1338     // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1339     // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1340     //
1341     // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
1342     // ignore that possibility;  Sema should diagnose it.
1343     if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1344       UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1345         cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1346     } else {
1347       UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1348     }
1349   }
1350   else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1351       UseAlignAttrOnly =
1352         D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1353         cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1354 
1355   // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1356   // else about the declaration and its type.
1357   if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
1358     // do nothing
1359 
1360   } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
1361     QualType T = VD->getType();
1362     if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
1363       if (ForAlignof)
1364         T = RT->getPointeeType();
1365       else
1366         T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1367     }
1368     QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1369     if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
1370       // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1371       // large-array alignment on the target.
1372       if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
1373         unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1374         if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
1375           if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1376             Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1377           else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1378                    MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1379             Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1380         }
1381       }
1382       Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
1383       if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1384         if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
1385           Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1386       }
1387     }
1388 
1389     // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1390     // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1391     // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack).  So calculate
1392     // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1393     // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
1394     if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1395       const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1396       // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1397       if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1398         const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
1399 
1400         // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1401         unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1402 
1403         // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1404         uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1405         if (Offset > 0) {
1406           // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1407           // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1408           uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1409           if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1410             FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1411         }
1412 
1413         Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
1414       }
1415     }
1416   }
1417 
1418   return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
1419 }
1420 
1421 // getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1422 // chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned.  This is
1423 // the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1424 // using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1425 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1426 ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1427   std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1428 
1429   // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1430   // of a base-class subobject.  We decide whether that's possible
1431   // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1432   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1433     if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1434       const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1435       sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1436     }
1437   }
1438 
1439   return sizeAndAlign;
1440 }
1441 
1442 /// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1443 /// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1444 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1445 static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1446                                    const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1447   std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1448       Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1449   uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
1450   assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1451               (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1452          "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1453   uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1454   unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
1455   if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1456       Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1457     Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1458   return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1459                         CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1460 }
1461 
1462 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1463 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
1464   if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1465     return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
1466   TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1467   return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1468                         toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
1469 }
1470 
1471 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1472 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
1473   return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1474 }
1475 
1476 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1477   return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1478 }
1479 
1480 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1481   return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1482 }
1483 
1484 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1485   TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1486   if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1487     return I->second;
1488 
1489   // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1490   TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1491   MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
1492   return TI;
1493 }
1494 
1495 /// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits.  This
1496 /// method does not work on incomplete types.
1497 ///
1498 /// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1499 /// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1500 /// should take a QualType, &c.
1501 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1502   uint64_t Width = 0;
1503   unsigned Align = 8;
1504   bool AlignIsRequired = false;
1505   switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
1506 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
1507 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
1508 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
1509 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
1510 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base)                       \
1511   case Type::Class:                                                            \
1512   assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here");      \
1513   return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1514 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
1515     llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
1516 
1517   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1518   case Type::FunctionProto:
1519     // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1520     Width = 0;
1521     Align = 32;
1522     break;
1523 
1524   case Type::IncompleteArray:
1525   case Type::VariableArray:
1526     Width = 0;
1527     Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1528     break;
1529 
1530   case Type::ConstantArray: {
1531     const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
1532 
1533     TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
1534     uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
1535     assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
1536            "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
1537     Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1538     Align = EltInfo.Align;
1539     if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1540         getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1541       Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1542     break;
1543   }
1544   case Type::ExtVector:
1545   case Type::Vector: {
1546     const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1547     TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1548     Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
1549     Align = Width;
1550     // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1551     // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
1552     if (Align & (Align-1)) {
1553       Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1554       Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1555     }
1556     // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1557     uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1558     if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1559       Align = TargetVectorAlign;
1560     break;
1561   }
1562 
1563   case Type::Builtin:
1564     switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
1565     default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
1566     case BuiltinType::Void:
1567       // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1568       Width = 0;
1569       Align = 8;
1570       break;
1571 
1572     case BuiltinType::Bool:
1573       Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1574       Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
1575       break;
1576     case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1577     case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1578     case BuiltinType::UChar:
1579     case BuiltinType::SChar:
1580       Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1581       Align = Target->getCharAlign();
1582       break;
1583     case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1584     case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
1585       Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1586       Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
1587       break;
1588     case BuiltinType::Char16:
1589       Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1590       Align = Target->getChar16Align();
1591       break;
1592     case BuiltinType::Char32:
1593       Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1594       Align = Target->getChar32Align();
1595       break;
1596     case BuiltinType::UShort:
1597     case BuiltinType::Short:
1598       Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1599       Align = Target->getShortAlign();
1600       break;
1601     case BuiltinType::UInt:
1602     case BuiltinType::Int:
1603       Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1604       Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1605       break;
1606     case BuiltinType::ULong:
1607     case BuiltinType::Long:
1608       Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1609       Align = Target->getLongAlign();
1610       break;
1611     case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
1612     case BuiltinType::LongLong:
1613       Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1614       Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
1615       break;
1616     case BuiltinType::Int128:
1617     case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1618       Width = 128;
1619       Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1620       break;
1621     case BuiltinType::Half:
1622       Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1623       Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1624       break;
1625     case BuiltinType::Float:
1626       Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1627       Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
1628       break;
1629     case BuiltinType::Double:
1630       Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1631       Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
1632       break;
1633     case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
1634       Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1635       Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
1636       break;
1637     case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
1638       Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1639       Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); //   == sizeof(void*)
1640       break;
1641     case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1642     case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1643     case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
1644       Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1645       Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1646       break;
1647     case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1648       // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1649       Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1650       Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1651       break;
1652     case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
1653     case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
1654     case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
1655     case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
1656     case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
1657     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1658     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1659     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1660     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1661     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1662     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth:
1663     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth:
1664     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA:
1665     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA:
1666     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth:
1667     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth:
1668     case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1669       // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1670       Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1671       Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1672       break;
1673     }
1674     break;
1675   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
1676     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1677     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1678     break;
1679   case Type::BlockPointer: {
1680     unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1681         cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
1682     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1683     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1684     break;
1685   }
1686   case Type::LValueReference:
1687   case Type::RValueReference: {
1688     // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1689     // the pointer route.
1690     unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1691         cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
1692     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1693     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1694     break;
1695   }
1696   case Type::Pointer: {
1697     unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
1698     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1699     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1700     break;
1701   }
1702   case Type::MemberPointer: {
1703     const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
1704     std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
1705     break;
1706   }
1707   case Type::Complex: {
1708     // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1709     // size.
1710     TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1711     Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1712     Align = EltInfo.Align;
1713     break;
1714   }
1715   case Type::ObjCObject:
1716     return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
1717   case Type::Adjusted:
1718   case Type::Decayed:
1719     return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
1720   case Type::ObjCInterface: {
1721     const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
1722     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
1723     Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
1724     Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1725     break;
1726   }
1727   case Type::Record:
1728   case Type::Enum: {
1729     const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1730 
1731     if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
1732       Width = 8;
1733       Align = 8;
1734       break;
1735     }
1736 
1737     if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1738       const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1739       TypeInfo Info =
1740           getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1741       if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1742         Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1743         Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1744       }
1745       return Info;
1746     }
1747 
1748     const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
1749     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1750     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
1751     Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
1752     Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1753     AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
1754     break;
1755   }
1756 
1757   case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
1758     return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1759                        getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
1760 
1761   case Type::Auto: {
1762     const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
1763     assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1764            "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
1765     return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
1766   }
1767 
1768   case Type::Paren:
1769     return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1770 
1771   case Type::Typedef: {
1772     const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
1773     TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
1774     // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1775     // alignment we have.  This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1776     // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
1777     if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
1778       Align = AttrAlign;
1779       AlignIsRequired = true;
1780     } else {
1781       Align = Info.Align;
1782       AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1783     }
1784     Width = Info.Width;
1785     break;
1786   }
1787 
1788   case Type::Elaborated:
1789     return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
1790 
1791   case Type::Attributed:
1792     return getTypeInfo(
1793                   cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1794 
1795   case Type::Atomic: {
1796     // Start with the base type information.
1797     TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1798     Width = Info.Width;
1799     Align = Info.Align;
1800 
1801     // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1802     // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1803     // favorable to atomic operations:
1804     if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1805       // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1806       if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1807         Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1808 
1809       // Set the alignment equal to the size.
1810       Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1811     }
1812   }
1813 
1814   }
1815 
1816   assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
1817   return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
1818 }
1819 
1820 unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1821   unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1822   // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1823   if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1824        getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1825       getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1826       T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1827     SimdAlign = 256;
1828   return SimdAlign;
1829 }
1830 
1831 /// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1832 CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1833   return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1834 }
1835 
1836 /// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1837 int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1838   return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1839 }
1840 
1841 /// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1842 /// This method does not work on incomplete types.
1843 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1844   return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
1845 }
1846 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
1847   return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
1848 }
1849 
1850 /// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
1851 /// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
1852 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
1853   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
1854 }
1855 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
1856   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
1857 }
1858 
1859 /// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1860 /// type for the current target in bits.  This can be different than the ABI
1861 /// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1862 /// a data type.
1863 unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
1864   TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1865   unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
1866 
1867   T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1868 
1869   // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
1870   if (T->isMemberPointerType())
1871     return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
1872 
1873   if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1874     return ABIAlign;  // Never overalign on XCore.
1875 
1876   // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
1877   if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
1878     T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1879   if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
1880     T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
1881   if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
1882       T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1883       T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
1884     // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1885     // typedef declaration.
1886     if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
1887       return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
1888 
1889   return ABIAlign;
1890 }
1891 
1892 /// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
1893 /// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
1894 /// value is specified.
1895 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned(void) const {
1896   return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
1897 }
1898 
1899 /// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1900 /// to a global variable of the specified type.
1901 unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1902   return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1903 }
1904 
1905 /// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1906 /// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1907 CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1908   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1909 }
1910 
1911 CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
1912   CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
1913   const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
1914   while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
1915     Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
1916     Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
1917   }
1918   return Offset;
1919 }
1920 
1921 /// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1922 /// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1923 /// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1924 /// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1925 /// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
1926 ///
1927 void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1928                                       bool leafClass,
1929                             SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
1930   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1931     DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1932   if (!leafClass) {
1933     for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1934       Ivars.push_back(I);
1935   } else {
1936     ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
1937     for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
1938          Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1939       Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1940   }
1941 }
1942 
1943 /// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1944 /// those inherited by it.
1945 void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
1946                           llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
1947   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
1948     // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1949     // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
1950     for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
1951       CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
1952     }
1953 
1954     // Categories of this Interface.
1955     for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1956       CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
1957 
1958     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1959       while (SD) {
1960         CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1961         SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1962       }
1963   } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
1964     for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
1965       CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
1966     }
1967   } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
1968     // Insert the protocol.
1969     if (!Protocols.insert(
1970           const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
1971       return;
1972 
1973     for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
1974       CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
1975   }
1976 }
1977 
1978 unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
1979   unsigned count = 0;
1980   // Count ivars declared in class extension.
1981   for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
1982     count += Ext->ivar_size();
1983 
1984   // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation.  This
1985   // includes synthesized ivars.
1986   if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
1987     count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1988 
1989   return count;
1990 }
1991 
1992 bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1993   if (!E)
1994     return false;
1995 
1996   // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1997   if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1998 
1999   if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2000       E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2001                                                 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2002     return true;
2003 
2004   // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2005   if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2006 
2007   return false;
2008 }
2009 
2010 /// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
2011 ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2012   llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2013     I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2014   if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2015     return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
2016   return nullptr;
2017 }
2018 /// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
2019 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2020   llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2021     I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2022   if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2023     return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
2024   return nullptr;
2025 }
2026 
2027 /// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2028 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2029                            ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2030   assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2031   ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2032 }
2033 /// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2034 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2035                            ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2036   assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2037   ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2038 }
2039 
2040 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2041                                               const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2042   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2043           dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2044     return ID;
2045   if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2046           dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2047     return CD->getClassInterface();
2048   if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2049           dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2050     return IMD->getClassInterface();
2051 
2052   return nullptr;
2053 }
2054 
2055 /// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
2056 /// none exists.
2057 Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
2058   assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2059   assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2060          "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
2061   llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
2062     I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
2063   return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
2064 }
2065 
2066 /// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2067 void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2068   assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
2069   assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2070          "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
2071   BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2072 }
2073 
2074 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
2075                                                  unsigned DataSize) const {
2076   if (!DataSize)
2077     DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2078   else
2079     assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
2080            "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
2081 
2082   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2083     (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2084   new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2085   return TInfo;
2086 }
2087 
2088 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
2089                                                      SourceLocation L) const {
2090   TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
2091   DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
2092   return DI;
2093 }
2094 
2095 const ASTRecordLayout &
2096 ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
2097   return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
2098 }
2099 
2100 const ASTRecordLayout &
2101 ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2102                                         const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
2103   return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2104 }
2105 
2106 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2107 //                   Type creation/memoization methods
2108 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2109 
2110 QualType
2111 ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2112   unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2113   quals.removeFastQualifiers();
2114 
2115   // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2116   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2117   ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
2118   void *insertPos = nullptr;
2119   if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2120     assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2121     return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
2122   }
2123 
2124   // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2125   QualType canon;
2126   if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2127     SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
2128     canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2129     canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
2130 
2131     // Re-find the insert position.
2132     (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2133   }
2134 
2135   ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2136   ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2137   return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
2138 }
2139 
2140 QualType
2141 ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
2142   QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2143   if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
2144     return T;
2145 
2146   // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2147   // into one ExtQuals node.
2148   QualifierCollector Quals;
2149   const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2150 
2151   // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2152   // another one.
2153   assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2154          "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2155   Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
2156 
2157   return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2158 }
2159 
2160 QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
2161                                        Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
2162   QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2163   if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
2164     return T;
2165 
2166   if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2167     QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
2168     if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
2169       QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2170       return getPointerType(ResultType);
2171     }
2172   }
2173 
2174   // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2175   // into one ExtQuals node.
2176   QualifierCollector Quals;
2177   const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2178 
2179   // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2180   // another one.
2181   assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2182          "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2183   Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
2184 
2185   return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2186 }
2187 
2188 const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2189                                                    FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2190   if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2191     return T;
2192 
2193   QualType Result;
2194   if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
2195     Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
2196   } else {
2197     const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2198     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2199     EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
2200     Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
2201   }
2202 
2203   return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2204 }
2205 
2206 void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2207                                                  QualType ResultType) {
2208   FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2209   while (true) {
2210     const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2211     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2212     FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
2213     if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2214       FD = Next;
2215     else
2216       break;
2217   }
2218   if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2219     L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
2220 }
2221 
2222 /// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2223 /// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2224 /// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2225 /// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2226 static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2227     ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2228     const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2229   // Might have some parens.
2230   if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2231     return Context.getParenType(
2232         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2233 
2234   // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2235   if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2236     return Context.getAttributedType(
2237         AT->getAttrKind(),
2238         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2239         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2240                                          ESI));
2241 
2242   // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2243   // specification.
2244   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2245   return Context.getFunctionType(
2246       Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2247       Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2248 }
2249 
2250 void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2251     FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2252     bool AsWritten) {
2253   // Update the type.
2254   QualType Updated =
2255       getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2256   FD->setType(Updated);
2257 
2258   if (!AsWritten)
2259     return;
2260 
2261   // Update the type in the type source information too.
2262   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2263     // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2264     // the type-as-written too.
2265     if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2266       Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2267 
2268     // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2269     // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2270     // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2271     assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2272                TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2273            "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2274     TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2275   }
2276 }
2277 
2278 /// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2279 /// number with the specified element type.
2280 QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
2281   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2282   // structure.
2283   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2284   ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
2285 
2286   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2287   if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2288     return QualType(CT, 0);
2289 
2290   // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2291   // so fill in the canonical type field.
2292   QualType Canonical;
2293   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
2294     Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
2295 
2296     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2297     ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2298     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2299   }
2300   ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
2301   Types.push_back(New);
2302   ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2303   return QualType(New, 0);
2304 }
2305 
2306 /// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2307 /// the specified type.
2308 QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
2309   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2310   // structure.
2311   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2312   PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
2313 
2314   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2315   if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2316     return QualType(PT, 0);
2317 
2318   // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2319   // so fill in the canonical type field.
2320   QualType Canonical;
2321   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
2322     Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
2323 
2324     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2325     PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2326     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2327   }
2328   PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
2329   Types.push_back(New);
2330   PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2331   return QualType(New, 0);
2332 }
2333 
2334 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2335   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2336   AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
2337   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2338   AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2339   if (AT)
2340     return QualType(AT, 0);
2341 
2342   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2343 
2344   // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2345   AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2346   assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
2347 
2348   AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2349       AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2350   Types.push_back(AT);
2351   AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2352   return QualType(AT, 0);
2353 }
2354 
2355 QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2356   assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2357 
2358   QualType Decayed;
2359 
2360   // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2361   //   A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2362   //   adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2363   //   qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2364   //   the array type derivation.
2365   if (T->isArrayType())
2366     Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2367 
2368   // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2369   //   A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2370   //   shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2371   //   in 6.3.2.1.
2372   if (T->isFunctionType())
2373     Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2374 
2375   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2376   AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
2377   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2378   AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2379   if (AT)
2380     return QualType(AT, 0);
2381 
2382   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2383 
2384   // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2385   AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2386   assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
2387 
2388   AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2389   Types.push_back(AT);
2390   AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2391   return QualType(AT, 0);
2392 }
2393 
2394 /// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
2395 /// a pointer to the specified block.
2396 QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
2397   assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2398   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
2399   // structure.
2400   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2401   BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
2402 
2403   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2404   if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2405         BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2406     return QualType(PT, 0);
2407 
2408   // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2409   // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2410   QualType Canonical;
2411   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
2412     Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
2413 
2414     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2415     BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2416       BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2417     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2418   }
2419   BlockPointerType *New
2420     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
2421   Types.push_back(New);
2422   BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2423   return QualType(New, 0);
2424 }
2425 
2426 /// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2427 /// lvalue reference to the specified type.
2428 QualType
2429 ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
2430   assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2431          "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2432 
2433   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2434   // structure.
2435   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2436   ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
2437 
2438   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2439   if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2440         LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2441     return QualType(RT, 0);
2442 
2443   const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2444 
2445   // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2446   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2447   QualType Canonical;
2448   if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2449     QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2450     Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
2451 
2452     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2453     LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2454       LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2455     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2456   }
2457 
2458   LValueReferenceType *New
2459     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2460                                                      SpelledAsLValue);
2461   Types.push_back(New);
2462   LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2463 
2464   return QualType(New, 0);
2465 }
2466 
2467 /// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2468 /// rvalue reference to the specified type.
2469 QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
2470   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2471   // structure.
2472   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2473   ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
2474 
2475   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2476   if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2477         RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2478     return QualType(RT, 0);
2479 
2480   const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2481 
2482   // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2483   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2484   QualType Canonical;
2485   if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2486     QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2487     Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
2488 
2489     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2490     RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2491       RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2492     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2493   }
2494 
2495   RValueReferenceType *New
2496     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
2497   Types.push_back(New);
2498   RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2499   return QualType(New, 0);
2500 }
2501 
2502 /// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2503 /// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
2504 QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
2505   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2506   // structure.
2507   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2508   MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2509 
2510   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2511   if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2512       MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2513     return QualType(PT, 0);
2514 
2515   // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2516   // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2517   QualType Canonical;
2518   if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2519     Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2520 
2521     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2522     MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2523       MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2524     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2525   }
2526   MemberPointerType *New
2527     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
2528   Types.push_back(New);
2529   MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2530   return QualType(New, 0);
2531 }
2532 
2533 /// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
2534 /// array of the specified element type.
2535 QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2536                                           const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
2537                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2538                                           unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
2539   assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2540           EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
2541          "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2542 
2543   // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2544   // the target.
2545   llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
2546   ArySize =
2547     ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
2548 
2549   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2550   ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
2551 
2552   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2553   if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
2554       ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2555     return QualType(ATP, 0);
2556 
2557   // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2558   // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2559   QualType Canon;
2560   if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2561     SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
2562     Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
2563                                  ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
2564     Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
2565 
2566     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2567     ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
2568       ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2569     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2570   }
2571 
2572   ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
2573     ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
2574   ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2575   Types.push_back(New);
2576   return QualType(New, 0);
2577 }
2578 
2579 /// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2580 /// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2581 /// sizes replaced with [*].
2582 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2583   // Vastly most common case.
2584   if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
2585 
2586   QualType result;
2587 
2588   SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
2589   const Type *ty = split.Ty;
2590   switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2591 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
2592 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2593 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2594 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2595     llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2596 
2597   // These types should never be variably-modified.
2598   case Type::Builtin:
2599   case Type::Complex:
2600   case Type::Vector:
2601   case Type::ExtVector:
2602   case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2603   case Type::ObjCObject:
2604   case Type::ObjCInterface:
2605   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2606   case Type::Record:
2607   case Type::Enum:
2608   case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2609   case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2610   case Type::TypeOf:
2611   case Type::Decltype:
2612   case Type::UnaryTransform:
2613   case Type::DependentName:
2614   case Type::InjectedClassName:
2615   case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2616   case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2617   case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2618   case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
2619   case Type::Auto:
2620   case Type::PackExpansion:
2621     llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2622 
2623   // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2624   // further decay.
2625   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2626   case Type::FunctionProto:
2627   case Type::BlockPointer:
2628   case Type::MemberPointer:
2629     return type;
2630 
2631   // These types can be variably-modified.  All these modifications
2632   // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2633   // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2634   // optimizations available here.
2635   case Type::Pointer:
2636     result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2637                               cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2638     break;
2639 
2640   case Type::LValueReference: {
2641     const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2642     result = getLValueReferenceType(
2643                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2644                                     lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2645     break;
2646   }
2647 
2648   case Type::RValueReference: {
2649     const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2650     result = getRValueReferenceType(
2651                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2652     break;
2653   }
2654 
2655   case Type::Atomic: {
2656     const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2657     result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2658     break;
2659   }
2660 
2661   case Type::ConstantArray: {
2662     const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2663     result = getConstantArrayType(
2664                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2665                                   cat->getSize(),
2666                                   cat->getSizeModifier(),
2667                                   cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2668     break;
2669   }
2670 
2671   case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2672     const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2673     result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2674                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2675                                         dat->getSizeExpr(),
2676                                         dat->getSizeModifier(),
2677                                         dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2678                                         dat->getBracketsRange());
2679     break;
2680   }
2681 
2682   // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2683   case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2684     const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2685     result = getVariableArrayType(
2686                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
2687                                   /*size*/ nullptr,
2688                                   ArrayType::Normal,
2689                                   iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2690                                   SourceRange());
2691     break;
2692   }
2693 
2694   // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2695   case Type::VariableArray: {
2696     const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2697     result = getVariableArrayType(
2698                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
2699                                   /*size*/ nullptr,
2700                                   ArrayType::Star,
2701                                   vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2702                                   vat->getBracketsRange());
2703     break;
2704   }
2705   }
2706 
2707   // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
2708   return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
2709 }
2710 
2711 /// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2712 /// variable array of the specified element type.
2713 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2714                                           Expr *NumElts,
2715                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2716                                           unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
2717                                           SourceRange Brackets) const {
2718   // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2719   // that have an expression provided for their size.
2720   QualType Canon;
2721 
2722   // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2723   if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2724     SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
2725     Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
2726                                  IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
2727     Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
2728   }
2729 
2730   VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
2731     VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
2732 
2733   VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2734   Types.push_back(New);
2735   return QualType(New, 0);
2736 }
2737 
2738 /// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2739 /// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
2740 /// type.
2741 QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2742                                                 Expr *numElements,
2743                                                 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2744                                                 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2745                                                 SourceRange brackets) const {
2746   assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2747           numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
2748          "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2749 
2750   // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2751   // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2752   // initializer.  We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2753   // because they can't be used in most locations.
2754   if (!numElements) {
2755     DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2756       = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2757           DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2758                                   numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2759                                   brackets);
2760     Types.push_back(newType);
2761     return QualType(newType, 0);
2762   }
2763 
2764   // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2765   // also build a canonical type.
2766 
2767   SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2768 
2769   void *insertPos = nullptr;
2770   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2771   DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
2772                                    QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
2773                                    ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
2774 
2775   // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2776   DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2777     DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2778 
2779   // If we don't have one, build one.
2780   if (!canonTy) {
2781     canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2782       DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
2783                               QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2784                               brackets);
2785     DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2786     Types.push_back(canonTy);
2787   }
2788 
2789   // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2790   QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
2791                                     canonElementType.Quals);
2792 
2793   // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
2794   // expression, then just use that as our result.
2795   if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
2796       canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
2797     return canon;
2798 
2799   // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2800   // of the element type.
2801   DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2802     = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2803         DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2804                                 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2805   Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2806   return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
2807 }
2808 
2809 QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
2810                                             ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2811                                             unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
2812   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2813   IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
2814 
2815   void *insertPos = nullptr;
2816   if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2817        IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2818     return QualType(iat, 0);
2819 
2820   // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2821   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.  We also have to pull
2822   // qualifiers off the element type.
2823   QualType canon;
2824 
2825   if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2826     SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2827     canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
2828                                    ASM, elementTypeQuals);
2829     canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
2830 
2831     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2832     IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2833       IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2834     assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
2835   }
2836 
2837   IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2838     IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
2839 
2840   IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2841   Types.push_back(newType);
2842   return QualType(newType, 0);
2843 }
2844 
2845 /// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2846 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
2847 QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
2848                                    VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
2849   assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
2850 
2851   // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2852   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2853   VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
2854 
2855   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2856   if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2857     return QualType(VTP, 0);
2858 
2859   // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2860   // so fill in the canonical type field.
2861   QualType Canonical;
2862   if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
2863     Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
2864 
2865     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2866     VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2867     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2868   }
2869   VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2870     VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
2871   VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2872   Types.push_back(New);
2873   return QualType(New, 0);
2874 }
2875 
2876 /// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
2877 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
2878 QualType
2879 ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
2880   assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
2881 
2882   // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2883   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2884   VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
2885                       VectorType::GenericVector);
2886   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2887   if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2888     return QualType(VTP, 0);
2889 
2890   // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2891   // so fill in the canonical type field.
2892   QualType Canonical;
2893   if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
2894     Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
2895 
2896     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2897     VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2898     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2899   }
2900   ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2901     ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
2902   VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2903   Types.push_back(New);
2904   return QualType(New, 0);
2905 }
2906 
2907 QualType
2908 ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2909                                            Expr *SizeExpr,
2910                                            SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
2911   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2912   DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
2913                                        SizeExpr);
2914 
2915   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2916   DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2917     = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2918   DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2919   if (Canon) {
2920     // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2921     // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
2922     New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2923       DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2924                                   SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
2925   } else {
2926     QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2927     if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
2928       New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2929         DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2930                                     AttrLoc);
2931 
2932       DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2933         = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2934       assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2935       (void)CanonCheck;
2936       DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2937     } else {
2938       QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2939                                                       SourceLocation());
2940       New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2941         DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
2942     }
2943   }
2944 
2945   Types.push_back(New);
2946   return QualType(New, 0);
2947 }
2948 
2949 /// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
2950 ///
2951 QualType
2952 ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2953                                    const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
2954   const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2955 
2956   // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2957   // structure.
2958   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2959   FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
2960 
2961   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2962   if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
2963         FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2964     return QualType(FT, 0);
2965 
2966   QualType Canonical;
2967   if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2968     Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
2969 
2970     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2971     FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2972       FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2973     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2974   }
2975 
2976   FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
2977   FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2978     FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
2979   Types.push_back(New);
2980   FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2981   return QualType(New, 0);
2982 }
2983 
2984 /// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2985 static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2986   return T.isCanonical() &&
2987          (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2988           T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2989 }
2990 
2991 QualType
2992 ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
2993                             const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
2994   size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2995 
2996   // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2997   // structure.
2998   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2999   FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
3000                              *this);
3001 
3002   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3003   if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
3004         FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3005     return QualType(FTP, 0);
3006 
3007   // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
3008   bool isCanonical =
3009     EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
3010     !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
3011   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
3012     if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
3013       isCanonical = false;
3014 
3015   // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
3016   // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
3017   QualType Canonical;
3018   if (!isCanonical) {
3019     SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
3020     CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3021     for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3022       CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
3023 
3024     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
3025     CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
3026     CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
3027 
3028     // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3029     QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
3030     if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3031       Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
3032       Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3033       CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
3034     }
3035 
3036     Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
3037 
3038     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3039     FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3040       FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3041     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3042   }
3043 
3044   // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3045   // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3046   //  - parameter types
3047   //  - exception types
3048   //  - consumed-arguments flags
3049   // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
3050   // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3051   // specification.
3052   size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
3053                 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
3054   if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3055     Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3056   } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
3057     Size += sizeof(Expr*);
3058   } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
3059     Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
3060   } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
3061     Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
3062   }
3063   if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
3064     Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
3065 
3066   FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3067   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
3068   new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
3069   Types.push_back(FTP);
3070   FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
3071   return QualType(FTP, 0);
3072 }
3073 
3074 #ifndef NDEBUG
3075 static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3076   if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3077   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3078   if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3079     return true;
3080   if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3081       !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3082     return true;
3083   return false;
3084 }
3085 #endif
3086 
3087 /// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3088 /// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3089 QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
3090                                               QualType TST) const {
3091   assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3092   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3093     assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3094   } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
3095     assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3096     Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3097     assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3098   } else {
3099     Type *newType =
3100       new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
3101     Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3102     Types.push_back(newType);
3103   }
3104   return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3105 }
3106 
3107 /// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3108 /// specified type declaration.
3109 QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
3110   assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
3111   assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
3112 
3113   if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
3114     return getTypedefType(Typedef);
3115 
3116   assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3117          "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3118 
3119   if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
3120     assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
3121     assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
3122     return getRecordType(Record);
3123   } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
3124     assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
3125     return getEnumType(Enum);
3126   } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
3127                dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
3128     Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3129     Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3130     Types.push_back(newType);
3131   } else
3132     llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
3133 
3134   return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3135 }
3136 
3137 /// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3138 /// specified typedef name decl.
3139 QualType
3140 ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3141                            QualType Canonical) const {
3142   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3143 
3144   if (Canonical.isNull())
3145     Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
3146   TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
3147     TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
3148   Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3149   Types.push_back(newType);
3150   return QualType(newType, 0);
3151 }
3152 
3153 QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
3154   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3155 
3156   if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
3157     if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3158       return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3159 
3160   RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3161   Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3162   Types.push_back(newType);
3163   return QualType(newType, 0);
3164 }
3165 
3166 QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
3167   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3168 
3169   if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
3170     if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3171       return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3172 
3173   EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3174   Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3175   Types.push_back(newType);
3176   return QualType(newType, 0);
3177 }
3178 
3179 QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3180                                        QualType modifiedType,
3181                                        QualType equivalentType) {
3182   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3183   AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3184 
3185   void *insertPos = nullptr;
3186   AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3187   if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3188 
3189   QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3190   type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3191            AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3192 
3193   Types.push_back(type);
3194   AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3195 
3196   return QualType(type, 0);
3197 }
3198 
3199 
3200 /// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3201 QualType
3202 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3203                                          QualType Replacement) const {
3204   assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
3205          && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3206 
3207   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3208   SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
3209   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3210   SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3211     = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3212 
3213   if (!SubstParm) {
3214     SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3215       SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3216     Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3217     SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3218   }
3219 
3220   return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3221 }
3222 
3223 /// \brief Retrieve a
3224 QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3225                                           const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3226                                               const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3227 #ifndef NDEBUG
3228   for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3229     assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3230     assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
3231   }
3232 #endif
3233 
3234   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3235   SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
3236   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3237   if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3238         = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3239     return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3240 
3241   QualType Canon;
3242   if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3243     Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3244     Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3245                                              ArgPack);
3246     SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3247   }
3248 
3249   SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3250     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3251                                                                ArgPack);
3252   Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3253   SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3254   return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3255 }
3256 
3257 /// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
3258 /// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
3259 /// name.
3260 QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
3261                                              bool ParameterPack,
3262                                              TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
3263   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3264   TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
3265   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3266   TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
3267     = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3268 
3269   if (TypeParm)
3270     return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3271 
3272   if (TTPDecl) {
3273     QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
3274     TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
3275 
3276     TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3277       = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3278     assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3279     (void)TypeCheck;
3280   } else
3281     TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3282       TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
3283 
3284   Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3285   TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3286 
3287   return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3288 }
3289 
3290 TypeSourceInfo *
3291 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3292                                               SourceLocation NameLoc,
3293                                         const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
3294                                               QualType Underlying) const {
3295   assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3296          "No dependent template names here!");
3297   QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
3298 
3299   TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
3300   TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3301       DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
3302   TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
3303   TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3304   TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3305   TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3306   for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3307     TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3308   return DI;
3309 }
3310 
3311 QualType
3312 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3313                                           const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
3314                                           QualType Underlying) const {
3315   assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3316          "No dependent template names here!");
3317 
3318   unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3319 
3320   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
3321   ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3322   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3323     ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3324 
3325   return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
3326                                        Underlying);
3327 }
3328 
3329 #ifndef NDEBUG
3330 static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3331                                  unsigned NumArgs) {
3332   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3333     if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3334       return true;
3335 
3336   return true;
3337 }
3338 #endif
3339 
3340 QualType
3341 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3342                                           const TemplateArgument *Args,
3343                                           unsigned NumArgs,
3344                                           QualType Underlying) const {
3345   assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3346          "No dependent template names here!");
3347   // Look through qualified template names.
3348   if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3349     Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
3350 
3351   bool IsTypeAlias =
3352     Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3353     isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
3354   QualType CanonType;
3355   if (!Underlying.isNull())
3356     CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3357   else {
3358     // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3359     // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3360     assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3361            "Caller must compute aliased type");
3362     IsTypeAlias = false;
3363     CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3364                                                        NumArgs);
3365   }
3366 
3367   // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3368   // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3369   // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
3370   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3371                        sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
3372                        (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
3373                        TypeAlignment);
3374   TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3375     = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3376                                          IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
3377 
3378   Types.push_back(Spec);
3379   return QualType(Spec, 0);
3380 }
3381 
3382 QualType
3383 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3384                                                    const TemplateArgument *Args,
3385                                                    unsigned NumArgs) const {
3386   assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3387          "No dependent template names here!");
3388 
3389   // Look through qualified template names.
3390   if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3391     Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
3392 
3393   // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3394   TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
3395   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
3396   CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3397   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3398     CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3399 
3400   // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3401   // exists.
3402   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3403   TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3404                                       CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3405 
3406   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3407   TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3408     = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3409 
3410   if (!Spec) {
3411     // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3412     void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3413                           sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3414                          TypeAlignment);
3415     Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3416                                                 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
3417                                                 QualType(), QualType());
3418     Types.push_back(Spec);
3419     TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3420   }
3421 
3422   assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3423          "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3424   return QualType(Spec, 0);
3425 }
3426 
3427 QualType
3428 ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3429                               NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3430                               QualType NamedType) const {
3431   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3432   ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
3433 
3434   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3435   ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3436   if (T)
3437     return QualType(T, 0);
3438 
3439   QualType Canon = NamedType;
3440   if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3441     Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
3442     ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3443     assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
3444     (void)CheckT;
3445   }
3446 
3447   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
3448   Types.push_back(T);
3449   ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3450   return QualType(T, 0);
3451 }
3452 
3453 QualType
3454 ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
3455   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3456   ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3457 
3458   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3459   ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3460   if (T)
3461     return QualType(T, 0);
3462 
3463   QualType Canon = InnerType;
3464   if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3465     Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3466     ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3467     assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3468     (void)CheckT;
3469   }
3470 
3471   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3472   Types.push_back(T);
3473   ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3474   return QualType(T, 0);
3475 }
3476 
3477 QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3478                                           NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3479                                           const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3480                                           QualType Canon) const {
3481   if (Canon.isNull()) {
3482     NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
3483     ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3484     if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3485       CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3486 
3487     if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3488       Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
3489   }
3490 
3491   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3492   DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
3493 
3494   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3495   DependentNameType *T
3496     = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3497   if (T)
3498     return QualType(T, 0);
3499 
3500   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
3501   Types.push_back(T);
3502   DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3503   return QualType(T, 0);
3504 }
3505 
3506 QualType
3507 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3508                                  ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3509                                  NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3510                                  const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3511                                  const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
3512   // TODO: avoid this copy
3513   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
3514   for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3515     ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3516   return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3517                                                 ArgCopy.size(),
3518                                                 ArgCopy.data());
3519 }
3520 
3521 QualType
3522 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3523                                  ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3524                                  NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3525                                  const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3526                                  unsigned NumArgs,
3527                                  const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
3528   assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3529          "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
3530 
3531   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3532   DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3533                                                Name, NumArgs, Args);
3534 
3535   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3536   DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3537     = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3538   if (T)
3539     return QualType(T, 0);
3540 
3541   NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
3542 
3543   ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3544   if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3545 
3546   bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
3547   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
3548   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3549     CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3550     if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3551       AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
3552   }
3553 
3554   QualType Canon;
3555   if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3556     Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3557                                                    Name, NumArgs,
3558                                                    CanonArgs.data());
3559 
3560     // Find the insert position again.
3561     DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3562   }
3563 
3564   void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3565                         sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3566                        TypeAlignment);
3567   T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
3568                                                     Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
3569   Types.push_back(T);
3570   DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3571   return QualType(T, 0);
3572 }
3573 
3574 QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
3575                                           Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
3576   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3577   PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
3578 
3579   assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3580          "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
3581   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3582   PackExpansionType *T
3583     = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3584   if (T)
3585     return QualType(T, 0);
3586 
3587   QualType Canon;
3588   if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
3589     Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3590     // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3591     // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3592     // parameters.
3593     if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
3594       Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
3595 
3596       // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3597       // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3598       PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3599     }
3600   }
3601 
3602   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3603       PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
3604   Types.push_back(T);
3605   PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3606   return QualType(T, 0);
3607 }
3608 
3609 /// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3610 /// alphabetically.
3611 static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
3612                             ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
3613   return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
3614 }
3615 
3616 static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
3617                                 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3618   if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3619 
3620   if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3621     return false;
3622 
3623   for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
3624     if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
3625         Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
3626       return false;
3627   return true;
3628 }
3629 
3630 static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
3631                                    unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3632   ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
3633 
3634   // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3635   llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd, CmpProtocolNames);
3636 
3637   // Canonicalize.
3638   for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3639     Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3640 
3641   // Remove duplicates.
3642   ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3643   NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3644 }
3645 
3646 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3647                                        ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
3648                                        unsigned NumProtocols) const {
3649   return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, { },
3650                            llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
3651                            /*isKindOf=*/false);
3652 }
3653 
3654 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
3655            QualType baseType,
3656            ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
3657            ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
3658            bool isKindOf) const {
3659   // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
3660   // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3661   if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
3662       isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
3663     return baseType;
3664 
3665   // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
3666   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3667   ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
3668   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3669   if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3670     return QualType(QT, 0);
3671 
3672   // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
3673   // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
3674   // type.
3675   ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
3676   if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
3677     if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
3678       effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
3679   }
3680 
3681   // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
3682   // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
3683   // canonicalized.
3684   QualType canonical;
3685   bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
3686                                           effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
3687                                           [&](QualType type) {
3688                                             return type.isCanonical();
3689                                           });
3690   bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols.data(),
3691                                              protocols.size());
3692   if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
3693     // Determine the canonical type arguments.
3694     ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
3695     SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
3696     if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
3697       canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
3698       for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
3699         canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
3700       canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
3701     } else {
3702       canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
3703     }
3704 
3705     ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
3706     SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
3707     if (!protocolsSorted) {
3708       canonProtocolsVec.insert(canonProtocolsVec.begin(),
3709                                protocols.begin(),
3710                                protocols.end());
3711       unsigned uniqueCount = protocols.size();
3712       SortAndUniqueProtocols(&canonProtocolsVec[0], uniqueCount);
3713       canonProtocols = llvm::makeArrayRef(&canonProtocolsVec[0], uniqueCount);
3714     } else {
3715       canonProtocols = protocols;
3716     }
3717 
3718     canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
3719                                   canonProtocols, isKindOf);
3720 
3721     // Regenerate InsertPos.
3722     ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3723   }
3724 
3725   unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3726   size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3727   size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3728   void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
3729   ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3730     new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
3731                                  isKindOf);
3732 
3733   Types.push_back(T);
3734   ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3735   return QualType(T, 0);
3736 }
3737 
3738 /// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3739 /// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3740 /// list.
3741 bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3742                                                 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3743   if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3744     return false;
3745 
3746   if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3747     // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3748     for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3749       if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3750         return false;
3751     }
3752     return true;
3753   }
3754   return false;
3755 }
3756 
3757 /// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3758 /// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3759 /// of protocols.
3760 bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3761                                                 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3762   if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3763     return false;
3764   const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3765   if (!OPT)
3766     return false;
3767   if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3768     return false;
3769   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3770   CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3771   if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3772     return false;
3773   // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3774   // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3775   bool Conforms = false;
3776   for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3777     Conforms = false;
3778     for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3779       if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3780         Conforms = true;
3781         break;
3782       }
3783     }
3784     if (!Conforms)
3785       break;
3786   }
3787   if (Conforms)
3788     return true;
3789 
3790   for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3791     // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3792     bool Adopts = false;
3793     for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3794       // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
3795       if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
3796         break;
3797     }
3798     if (!Adopts)
3799       return false;
3800   }
3801   return true;
3802 }
3803 
3804 /// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3805 /// the given object type.
3806 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
3807   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3808   ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3809 
3810   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3811   if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3812               ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3813     return QualType(QT, 0);
3814 
3815   // Find the canonical object type.
3816   QualType Canonical;
3817   if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3818     Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3819 
3820     // Regenerate InsertPos.
3821     ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3822   }
3823 
3824   // No match.
3825   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3826   ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3827     new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
3828 
3829   Types.push_back(QType);
3830   ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
3831   return QualType(QType, 0);
3832 }
3833 
3834 /// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3835 /// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
3836 QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3837                                           ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
3838   if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3839     return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3840 
3841   if (PrevDecl) {
3842     assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3843     Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3844     return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3845   }
3846 
3847   // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3848   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3849     Decl = Def;
3850 
3851   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3852   ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3853   Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3854   Types.push_back(T);
3855   return QualType(T, 0);
3856 }
3857 
3858 /// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3859 /// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
3860 /// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
3861 /// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
3862 /// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
3863 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
3864   TypeOfExprType *toe;
3865   if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3866     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3867     DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
3868 
3869     void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3870     DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3871       = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3872     if (Canon) {
3873       // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3874       // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
3875       toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
3876                                           QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
3877     } else {
3878       // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
3879       Canon
3880         = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
3881       DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3882       toe = Canon;
3883     }
3884   } else {
3885     QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
3886     toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
3887   }
3888   Types.push_back(toe);
3889   return QualType(toe, 0);
3890 }
3891 
3892 /// getTypeOfType -  Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3893 /// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3894 /// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
3895 /// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3896 /// on canonical types (which are always unique).
3897 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
3898   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
3899   TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
3900   Types.push_back(tot);
3901   return QualType(tot, 0);
3902 }
3903 
3904 
3905 /// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3906 /// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3907 /// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3908 /// is an Expr tree under each such type.
3909 QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
3910   DecltypeType *dt;
3911 
3912   // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
3913   //   If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
3914   //   unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3915   //   type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
3916   if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
3917     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3918     DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
3919 
3920     void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3921     DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3922       = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3923     if (!Canon) {
3924       // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
3925       Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
3926       DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3927     }
3928     dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3929         DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
3930   } else {
3931     dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3932         DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
3933   }
3934   Types.push_back(dt);
3935   return QualType(dt, 0);
3936 }
3937 
3938 /// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3939 /// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3940 QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3941                                            QualType UnderlyingType,
3942                                            UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3943     const {
3944   UnaryTransformType *Ty =
3945     new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3946                                                    Kind,
3947                                  UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
3948                                  QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
3949   Types.push_back(Ty);
3950   return QualType(Ty, 0);
3951 }
3952 
3953 /// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3954 /// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3955 /// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3956 QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
3957                                  bool IsDependent) const {
3958   if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
3959     return getAutoDeductType();
3960 
3961   // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
3962   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3963   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3964   AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
3965   if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3966     return QualType(AT, 0);
3967 
3968   AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
3969                                                      IsDecltypeAuto,
3970                                                      IsDependent);
3971   Types.push_back(AT);
3972   if (InsertPos)
3973     AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3974   return QualType(AT, 0);
3975 }
3976 
3977 /// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3978 /// the given value type.
3979 QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3980   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3981   // structure.
3982   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3983   AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3984 
3985   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3986   if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3987     return QualType(AT, 0);
3988 
3989   // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3990   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3991   QualType Canonical;
3992   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3993     Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3994 
3995     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3996     AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3997     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3998   }
3999   AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
4000   Types.push_back(New);
4001   AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4002   return QualType(New, 0);
4003 }
4004 
4005 /// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
4006 QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
4007   if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
4008     AutoDeductTy = QualType(
4009       new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
4010                                           /*dependent*/false),
4011       0);
4012   return AutoDeductTy;
4013 }
4014 
4015 /// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
4016 QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
4017   if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
4018     AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
4019   assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
4020   return AutoRRefDeductTy;
4021 }
4022 
4023 /// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4024 /// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
4025 QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
4026   assert (Decl);
4027   // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
4028   // away const?  mutable?
4029   return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
4030 }
4031 
4032 /// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4033 /// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4034 /// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
4035 CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
4036   return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
4037 }
4038 
4039 /// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4040 CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4041   return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4042 }
4043 
4044 /// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4045 CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4046   return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4047 }
4048 
4049 /// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4050 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4051 QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4052   // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4053   return WCharTy;
4054 }
4055 
4056 /// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4057 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4058 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4059   // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4060   return UnsignedIntTy;
4061 }
4062 
4063 QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4064   return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4065 }
4066 
4067 QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4068   return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4069 }
4070 
4071 /// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
4072 /// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4073 QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
4074   return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
4075 }
4076 
4077 /// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4078 /// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4079 QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4080   return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4081 }
4082 
4083 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4084 //                              Type Operators
4085 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4086 
4087 CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
4088   // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4089   // qualifiers.
4090   T = getCanonicalType(T);
4091   T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4092   const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
4093   QualType Result;
4094   if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4095     Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4096   } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4097     Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4098   } else {
4099     Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4100   }
4101 
4102   return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4103 }
4104 
4105 QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4106                                              Qualifiers &quals) {
4107   SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4108 
4109   // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4110   // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4111   // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4112   // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4113   const ArrayType *AT =
4114     dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
4115 
4116   // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
4117   if (!AT) {
4118     quals = splitType.Quals;
4119     return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
4120   }
4121 
4122   // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4123   QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4124   QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4125 
4126   // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4127   // can just use the results in splitType.
4128   if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4129     assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
4130     quals = splitType.Quals;
4131     return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
4132   }
4133 
4134   // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4135   // build the type back up.
4136   quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
4137 
4138   if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
4139     return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
4140                                 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4141   }
4142 
4143   if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
4144     return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4145   }
4146 
4147   if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
4148     return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
4149                                 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
4150                                 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4151                                 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4152                                 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4153   }
4154 
4155   const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
4156   return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
4157                                     DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4158                                     SourceRange());
4159 }
4160 
4161 /// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types  that
4162 /// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4163 /// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4164 /// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4165 /// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4166 /// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4167 /// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4168 /// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4169 bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4170   const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4171                     *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4172   if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4173     T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4174     T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4175     return true;
4176   }
4177 
4178   const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4179                           *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4180   if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4181       hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4182                              QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4183     T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4184     T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4185     return true;
4186   }
4187 
4188   if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
4189     const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4190                                 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4191     if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4192       T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4193       T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4194       return true;
4195     }
4196   }
4197 
4198   // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4199 
4200   return false;
4201 }
4202 
4203 DeclarationNameInfo
4204 ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4205                                SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
4206   switch (Name.getKind()) {
4207   case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4208   case TemplateName::Template:
4209     // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4210     return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4211                                NameLoc);
4212 
4213   case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4214     OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4215     // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4216     return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4217   }
4218 
4219   case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4220     DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4221     DeclarationName DName;
4222     if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
4223       DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4224       return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
4225     } else {
4226       DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4227       // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4228       DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4229       DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4230       DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4231       return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
4232     }
4233   }
4234 
4235   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4236     SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4237       = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4238     return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4239                                NameLoc);
4240   }
4241 
4242   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4243     SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4244       = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4245     return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4246                                NameLoc);
4247   }
4248   }
4249 
4250   llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
4251 }
4252 
4253 TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
4254   switch (Name.getKind()) {
4255   case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4256   case TemplateName::Template: {
4257     TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
4258     if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
4259           = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
4260       Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4261 
4262     // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
4263     return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
4264   }
4265 
4266   case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4267     llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
4268 
4269   case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4270     DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4271     assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4272     return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4273   }
4274 
4275   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4276     SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4277       = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4278     return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4279   }
4280 
4281   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4282     SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4283                                   = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4284     TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4285       = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4286     TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4287       = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4288     return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4289   }
4290   }
4291 
4292   llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
4293 }
4294 
4295 bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4296   X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4297   Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4298   return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4299 }
4300 
4301 TemplateArgument
4302 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
4303   switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4304     case TemplateArgument::Null:
4305       return Arg;
4306 
4307     case TemplateArgument::Expression:
4308       return Arg;
4309 
4310     case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
4311       ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4312       return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
4313     }
4314 
4315     case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4316       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4317                               /*isNullPtr*/true);
4318 
4319     case TemplateArgument::Template:
4320       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
4321 
4322     case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4323       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4324                                          Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
4325                               Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
4326 
4327     case TemplateArgument::Integral:
4328       return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
4329 
4330     case TemplateArgument::Type:
4331       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
4332 
4333     case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
4334       if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4335         return Arg;
4336 
4337       TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4338         = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
4339       unsigned Idx = 0;
4340       for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
4341                                         AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4342            A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4343         CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
4344 
4345       return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
4346     }
4347   }
4348 
4349   // Silence GCC warning
4350   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
4351 }
4352 
4353 NestedNameSpecifier *
4354 ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
4355   if (!NNS)
4356     return nullptr;
4357 
4358   switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4359   case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4360     // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
4361     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
4362                          getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4363                                        NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4364 
4365   case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4366     // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4367     // this namespace and no prefix.
4368     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
4369                                  NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4370 
4371   case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4372     // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4373     // this namespace and no prefix.
4374     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
4375                                     NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4376                                                       ->getOriginalNamespace());
4377 
4378   case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4379   case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4380     QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
4381 
4382     // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4383     // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4384     // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4385     // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4386     // types, e.g.,
4387     //   typedef typename T::type T1;
4388     //   typedef typename T1::type T2;
4389     if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4390       return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
4391                            const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
4392 
4393     // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4394     // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4395     // first place?
4396     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4397                                        const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
4398   }
4399 
4400   case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4401   case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4402     // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
4403     return NNS;
4404   }
4405 
4406   llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
4407 }
4408 
4409 
4410 const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
4411   // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
4412   if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
4413     // Handle the common positive case fast.
4414     if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4415       return AT;
4416   }
4417 
4418   // Handle the common negative case fast.
4419   if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
4420     return nullptr;
4421 
4422   // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type.  This
4423   // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4424   // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
4425 
4426   // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4427   // sugar such as a typedef in the way.  If we have type qualifiers on the type
4428   // we must propagate them down into the element type.
4429 
4430   SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
4431   Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
4432 
4433   // If we have a simple case, just return now.
4434   const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
4435   if (!ATy || qs.empty())
4436     return ATy;
4437 
4438   // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it.  Push the
4439   // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
4440   QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
4441 
4442   if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4443     return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4444                                                 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
4445                                            CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
4446   if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4447     return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4448                                                   IAT->getSizeModifier(),
4449                                            IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
4450 
4451   if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
4452         = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4453     return cast<ArrayType>(
4454                      getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
4455                                                 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
4456                                                 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
4457                                               DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4458                                                 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
4459 
4460   const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
4461   return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
4462                                               VAT->getSizeExpr(),
4463                                               VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4464                                               VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4465                                               VAT->getBracketsRange()));
4466 }
4467 
4468 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
4469   if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4470     return getDecayedType(T);
4471   return T;
4472 }
4473 
4474 QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
4475   T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4476   T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4477   return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4478 }
4479 
4480 QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
4481   // C++ [except.throw]p3:
4482   //   A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
4483   //   object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
4484   //   cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
4485   //   the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
4486   //   or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
4487   T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4488   if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4489     T = getDecayedType(T);
4490   return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4491 }
4492 
4493 /// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4494 /// specified array type to a pointer.  This operation is non-trivial when
4495 /// handling typedefs etc.  The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4496 /// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4497 ///
4498 /// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
4499 QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
4500   // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4501   // typedefs in the element type of the array.  This also handles propagation
4502   // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4503   // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4504   const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4505   assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
4506 
4507   QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
4508 
4509   // int x[restrict 4] ->  int *restrict
4510   return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
4511 }
4512 
4513 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4514   return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
4515 }
4516 
4517 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4518   Qualifiers qs;
4519   while (true) {
4520     SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
4521     const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
4522     if (!array) break;
4523 
4524     type = array->getElementType();
4525     qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
4526   }
4527 
4528   return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
4529 }
4530 
4531 /// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
4532 uint64_t
4533 ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA)  const {
4534   uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4535   do {
4536     ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
4537     CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4538       CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
4539   } while (CA);
4540   return ElementCount;
4541 }
4542 
4543 /// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4544 /// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
4545 static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
4546   if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
4547     return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
4548 
4549   assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4550   switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
4551   default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4552   case BuiltinType::Half:       return HalfRank;
4553   case BuiltinType::Float:      return FloatRank;
4554   case BuiltinType::Double:     return DoubleRank;
4555   case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
4556   }
4557 }
4558 
4559 /// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4560 /// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
4561 /// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4562 /// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
4563 QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4564                                                        QualType Domain) const {
4565   FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4566   if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4567     switch (EltRank) {
4568     case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
4569     case FloatRank:      return FloatComplexTy;
4570     case DoubleRank:     return DoubleComplexTy;
4571     case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4572     }
4573   }
4574 
4575   assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4576   switch (EltRank) {
4577   case HalfRank:       return HalfTy;
4578   case FloatRank:      return FloatTy;
4579   case DoubleRank:     return DoubleTy;
4580   case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
4581   }
4582   llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
4583 }
4584 
4585 /// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4586 /// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4587 /// '_Complex double').  If LHS > RHS, return 1.  If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
4588 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
4589 int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
4590   FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4591   FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
4592 
4593   if (LHSR == RHSR)
4594     return 0;
4595   if (LHSR > RHSR)
4596     return 1;
4597   return -1;
4598 }
4599 
4600 /// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4601 /// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4602 /// or if it is not canonicalized.
4603 unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
4604   assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
4605 
4606   switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
4607   default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
4608   case BuiltinType::Bool:
4609     return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
4610   case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4611   case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4612   case BuiltinType::SChar:
4613   case BuiltinType::UChar:
4614     return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
4615   case BuiltinType::Short:
4616   case BuiltinType::UShort:
4617     return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
4618   case BuiltinType::Int:
4619   case BuiltinType::UInt:
4620     return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
4621   case BuiltinType::Long:
4622   case BuiltinType::ULong:
4623     return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
4624   case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4625   case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
4626     return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
4627   case BuiltinType::Int128:
4628   case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4629     return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
4630   }
4631 }
4632 
4633 /// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4634 /// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4635 ///
4636 /// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4637 /// promotion occurs.
4638 QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
4639   if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4640     return QualType();
4641 
4642   // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
4643   // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
4644   // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
4645 
4646   FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
4647   if (!Field)
4648     return QualType();
4649 
4650   QualType FT = Field->getType();
4651 
4652   uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
4653   uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4654   // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
4655   //   A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
4656   //   int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
4657   //   can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
4658   //   values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
4659   //   promotion applies to it.
4660   // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
4661   //   [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
4662   //   If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
4663   //   the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
4664   //   it is converted to an unsigned int.
4665   //
4666   // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
4667   //        We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
4668   if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4669     return IntTy;
4670 
4671   if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4672     return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4673 
4674   // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4675   // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
4676   // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
4677   // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
4678   // into their semantics in some cases).
4679   return QualType();
4680 }
4681 
4682 /// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4683 /// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4684 /// integer type.
4685 QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
4686   assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4687   assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
4688   if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4689     return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
4690 
4691   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4692     // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4693     // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4694     // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4695     // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4696     // unsigned long long int [...]
4697     // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4698     if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4699         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4700         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4701         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4702       bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4703       uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4704       QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4705                                   LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4706       for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4707         uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4708         if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4709             (FromSize == ToSize &&
4710              FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4711           return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4712       }
4713       llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4714     }
4715   }
4716 
4717   // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
4718   if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4719     return IntTy;
4720   uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4721   uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
4722   assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4723   return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4724 }
4725 
4726 /// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4727 /// type and returns its ownership.
4728 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4729   while (!T.isNull()) {
4730     if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4731       return T.getObjCLifetime();
4732     if (T->isArrayType())
4733       T = getBaseElementType(T);
4734     else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4735       T = PT->getPointeeType();
4736     else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4737       T = RT->getPointeeType();
4738     else
4739       break;
4740   }
4741 
4742   return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4743 }
4744 
4745 static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4746   // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4747   // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4748   if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4749     return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
4750   return nullptr;
4751 }
4752 
4753 /// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
4754 /// C99 6.3.1.8p1.  If LHS > RHS, return 1.  If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
4755 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
4756 int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
4757   const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4758   const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
4759 
4760   // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4761   if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4762     LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4763   if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4764     RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4765 
4766   if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
4767 
4768   bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4769   bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4770 
4771   unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4772   unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
4773 
4774   if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) {  // Both signed or both unsigned.
4775     if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4776     return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4777   }
4778 
4779   // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4780   if (LHSUnsigned) {
4781     // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4782     if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4783       return 1;
4784 
4785     // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4786     // wins.  Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
4787     // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
4788     return -1;
4789   }
4790 
4791   // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4792   if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4793     return -1;
4794 
4795   // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4796   // wins.  Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
4797   // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
4798   return 1;
4799 }
4800 
4801 // getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
4802 QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
4803   if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
4804     CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
4805     CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
4806 
4807     QualType FieldTypes[4];
4808 
4809     // const int *isa;
4810     FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
4811     // int flags;
4812     FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
4813     // const char *str;
4814     FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
4815     // long length;
4816     FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4817 
4818     // Create fields
4819     for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
4820       FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
4821                                            SourceLocation(),
4822                                            SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4823                                            FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4824                                            /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
4825                                            /*Mutable=*/false,
4826                                            ICIS_NoInit);
4827       Field->setAccess(AS_public);
4828       CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
4829     }
4830 
4831     CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
4832   }
4833 
4834   return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
4835 }
4836 
4837 QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4838   if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
4839     RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
4840     TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4841     ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4842   }
4843   return ObjCSuperType;
4844 }
4845 
4846 void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
4847   const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
4848   assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4849   CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4850 }
4851 
4852 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
4853   if (BlockDescriptorType)
4854     return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4855 
4856   RecordDecl *RD;
4857   // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
4858   RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4859   RD->startDefinition();
4860 
4861   QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4862     UnsignedLongTy,
4863     UnsignedLongTy,
4864   };
4865 
4866   static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
4867     "reserved",
4868     "Size"
4869   };
4870 
4871   for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
4872     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4873         *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
4874         &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4875         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
4876     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
4877     RD->addDecl(Field);
4878   }
4879 
4880   RD->completeDefinition();
4881 
4882   BlockDescriptorType = RD;
4883 
4884   return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4885 }
4886 
4887 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
4888   if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4889     return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4890 
4891   RecordDecl *RD;
4892   // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
4893   RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4894   RD->startDefinition();
4895 
4896   QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4897     UnsignedLongTy,
4898     UnsignedLongTy,
4899     getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4900     getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4901   };
4902 
4903   static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
4904     "reserved",
4905     "Size",
4906     "CopyFuncPtr",
4907     "DestroyFuncPtr"
4908   };
4909 
4910   for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
4911     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4912         *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
4913         &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4914         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
4915         /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
4916     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
4917     RD->addDecl(Field);
4918   }
4919 
4920   RD->completeDefinition();
4921 
4922   BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
4923   return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4924 }
4925 
4926 /// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4927 /// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4928 /// in buildByrefHelpers.
4929 bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4930                                       const VarDecl *D) {
4931   if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4932     const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4933     if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4934 
4935     return true;
4936   }
4937 
4938   if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4939 
4940   Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4941 
4942   // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4943   if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4944     assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4945 
4946     switch (lifetime) {
4947       case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4948 
4949       // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4950       case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4951       case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4952         return false;
4953 
4954       // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4955       // byref routines.
4956       case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4957       // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4958       case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4959         return true;
4960     }
4961     llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4962   }
4963   return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4964           Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
4965 }
4966 
4967 bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4968                               Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4969                               bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4970 
4971   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4972       getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4973     return false;
4974 
4975   HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
4976   if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
4977     HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4978     LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4979   }
4980   else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4981     LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4982   // MRR.
4983   else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4984     LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4985   else
4986     LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4987   return true;
4988 }
4989 
4990 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4991   if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
4992     ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4993         buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
4994   return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4995 }
4996 
4997 // This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4998 // typedef <type> BOOL;
4999 static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
5000   if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
5001     if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
5002       return II->isStr("BOOL");
5003 
5004   return false;
5005 }
5006 
5007 /// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
5008 /// purpose.
5009 CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
5010   if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
5011     return CharUnits::Zero();
5012 
5013   CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
5014 
5015   // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
5016   if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
5017     sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
5018   // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
5019   else if (type->isArrayType())
5020     sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5021   return sz;
5022 }
5023 
5024 bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
5025   return getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
5026          VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5027          VD->isFirstDecl() && !VD->isOutOfLine() && VD->hasInit();
5028 }
5029 
5030 static inline
5031 std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5032   return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
5033 }
5034 
5035 /// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
5036 /// declaration.
5037 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5038   std::string S;
5039 
5040   const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5041   QualType BlockTy =
5042       Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5043   // Encode result type.
5044   if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
5045     getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5046         Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5047         true /*Extended*/);
5048   else
5049     getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
5050   // Compute size of all parameters.
5051   // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5052   // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5053   SourceLocation Loc;
5054   CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5055   CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
5056   for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
5057     QualType PType = PI->getType();
5058     CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5059     if (sz.isZero())
5060       continue;
5061     assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
5062     ParmOffset += sz;
5063   }
5064   // Size of the argument frame
5065   S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5066   // Block pointer and offset.
5067   S += "@?0";
5068 
5069   // Argument types.
5070   ParmOffset = PtrSize;
5071   for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
5072     QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5073     if (const ArrayType *AT =
5074           dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5075       // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5076       // elements.
5077       if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5078         PType = PVDecl->getType();
5079     } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5080       PType = PVDecl->getType();
5081     if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
5082       getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5083                                       S, true /*Extended*/);
5084     else
5085       getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5086     S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5087     ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5088   }
5089 
5090   return S;
5091 }
5092 
5093 bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
5094                                                 std::string& S) {
5095   // Encode result type.
5096   getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
5097   CharUnits ParmOffset;
5098   // Compute size of all parameters.
5099   for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
5100     QualType PType = PI->getType();
5101     CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5102     if (sz.isZero())
5103       continue;
5104 
5105     assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5106         "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
5107     ParmOffset += sz;
5108   }
5109   S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5110   ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5111 
5112   // Argument types.
5113   for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
5114     QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5115     if (const ArrayType *AT =
5116           dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5117       // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5118       // elements.
5119       if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5120         PType = PVDecl->getType();
5121     } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5122       PType = PVDecl->getType();
5123     getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5124     S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5125     ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5126   }
5127 
5128   return false;
5129 }
5130 
5131 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5132 /// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5133 /// block object types.
5134 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5135                                                    QualType T, std::string& S,
5136                                                    bool Extended) const {
5137   // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5138   getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5139   // Encode parameter type.
5140   getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5141                              true     /*OutermostType*/,
5142                              false    /*EncodingProperty*/,
5143                              false    /*StructField*/,
5144                              Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5145                              Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5146 }
5147 
5148 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
5149 /// declaration.
5150 bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
5151                                               std::string& S,
5152                                               bool Extended) const {
5153   // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5154   // Encode return type.
5155   getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5156                                     Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
5157   // Compute size of all parameters.
5158   // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5159   // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5160   SourceLocation Loc;
5161   CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5162   // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
5163   // their size.
5164   CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
5165   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
5166        E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
5167     QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
5168     CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5169     if (sz.isZero())
5170       continue;
5171 
5172     assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5173         "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
5174     ParmOffset += sz;
5175   }
5176   S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5177   S += "@0:";
5178   S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
5179 
5180   // Argument types.
5181   ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
5182   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
5183        E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
5184     const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
5185     QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5186     if (const ArrayType *AT =
5187           dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5188       // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5189       // elements.
5190       if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5191         PType = PVDecl->getType();
5192     } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5193       PType = PVDecl->getType();
5194     getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5195                                       PType, S, Extended);
5196     S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5197     ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5198   }
5199 
5200   return false;
5201 }
5202 
5203 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
5204 ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5205                                       const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5206                                       const Decl *Container) const {
5207   if (!Container)
5208     return nullptr;
5209   if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5210       dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
5211     for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5212       if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5213         return PID;
5214   } else {
5215     const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5216     for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5217       if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5218         return PID;
5219   }
5220   return nullptr;
5221 }
5222 
5223 /// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
5224 /// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
5225 /// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5226 /// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
5227 /// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5228 /// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5229 /// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5230 /// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5231 /// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
5232 /// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5233 /// @code
5234 /// enum PropertyAttributes {
5235 /// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R',   // property is read-only.
5236 /// kPropertyBycopy = 'C',     // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5237 /// kPropertyByref = '&',  // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5238 /// kPropertyDynamic = 'D',    // property is dynamic
5239 /// kPropertyGetter = 'G',     // followed by getter selector name
5240 /// kPropertySetter = 'S',     // followed by setter selector name
5241 /// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V'  // followed by instance variable  name
5242 /// kPropertyType = 'T'              // followed by old-style type encoding.
5243 /// kPropertyWeak = 'W'              // 'weak' property
5244 /// kPropertyStrong = 'P'            // property GC'able
5245 /// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N'         // property non-atomic
5246 /// };
5247 /// @endcode
5248 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5249                                                 const Decl *Container,
5250                                                 std::string& S) const {
5251   // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5252   bool Dynamic = false;
5253   ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
5254 
5255   if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5256       getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5257     if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5258       Dynamic = true;
5259     else
5260       SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
5261   }
5262 
5263   // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5264   S = "T";
5265 
5266   // Encode result type.
5267   // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5268   // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5269   getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
5270 
5271   if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5272     S += ",R";
5273     if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5274       S += ",C";
5275     if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5276       S += ",&";
5277     if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5278       S += ",W";
5279   } else {
5280     switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5281     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5282     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy:   S += ",C"; break;
5283     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
5284     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak:   S += ",W"; break;
5285     }
5286   }
5287 
5288   // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5289   // are "dynamic by default".
5290   if (Dynamic)
5291     S += ",D";
5292 
5293   if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5294     S += ",N";
5295 
5296   if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5297     S += ",G";
5298     S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
5299   }
5300 
5301   if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5302     S += ",S";
5303     S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
5304   }
5305 
5306   if (SynthesizePID) {
5307     const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5308     S += ",V";
5309     S += OID->getNameAsString();
5310   }
5311 
5312   // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5313 }
5314 
5315 /// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
5316 /// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5317 /// 'l' or 'L' , but not always.  For typedefs, we need to use
5318 /// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5319 ///
5320 void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
5321   if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
5322     if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5323       if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
5324         PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
5325       else
5326         if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
5327           PointeeTy = IntTy;
5328     }
5329   }
5330 }
5331 
5332 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
5333                                         const FieldDecl *Field,
5334                                         QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
5335   // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5336   // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5337   // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5338   // same type.
5339   getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
5340                              true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5341                              false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
5342 }
5343 
5344 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5345                                                 std::string& S) const {
5346   // Encode result type.
5347   // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5348   // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5349   getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5350                              true /* outermost type */,
5351                              true /* encoding property */);
5352 }
5353 
5354 static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5355                                             BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5356     switch (kind) {
5357     case BuiltinType::Void:       return 'v';
5358     case BuiltinType::Bool:       return 'B';
5359     case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5360     case BuiltinType::UChar:      return 'C';
5361     case BuiltinType::Char16:
5362     case BuiltinType::UShort:     return 'S';
5363     case BuiltinType::Char32:
5364     case BuiltinType::UInt:       return 'I';
5365     case BuiltinType::ULong:
5366         return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
5367     case BuiltinType::UInt128:    return 'T';
5368     case BuiltinType::ULongLong:  return 'Q';
5369     case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5370     case BuiltinType::SChar:      return 'c';
5371     case BuiltinType::Short:      return 's';
5372     case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5373     case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
5374     case BuiltinType::Int:        return 'i';
5375     case BuiltinType::Long:
5376       return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
5377     case BuiltinType::LongLong:   return 'q';
5378     case BuiltinType::Int128:     return 't';
5379     case BuiltinType::Float:      return 'f';
5380     case BuiltinType::Double:     return 'd';
5381     case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
5382     case BuiltinType::NullPtr:    return '*'; // like char*
5383 
5384     case BuiltinType::Half:
5385       // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5386       return ' ';
5387 
5388     case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5389     case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5390     case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5391       llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5392 
5393     // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5394     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5395     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5396     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5397     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5398     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5399     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dDepth:
5400     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayDepth:
5401     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAA:
5402     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAA:
5403     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dMSAADepth:
5404     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArrayMSAADepth:
5405     case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
5406     case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
5407     case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
5408     case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
5409     case BuiltinType::OCLNDRange:
5410     case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
5411     case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
5412     case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5413 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5414 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5415     case BuiltinType::KIND:
5416 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5417       llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
5418     }
5419     llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
5420 }
5421 
5422 static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5423   EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5424 
5425   // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5426   if (!Enum->isFixed())
5427     return 'i';
5428 
5429   // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
5430   const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5431   return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
5432 }
5433 
5434 static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
5435                            QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
5436   assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
5437   S += 'b';
5438   // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5439   // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5440   // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5441   // bitfield, then the size in bits.  For example, in this structure:
5442   //
5443   // struct
5444   // {
5445   //    int integer;
5446   //    int flags:2;
5447   // };
5448   // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5449   // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime.  The reason for this extra
5450   // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5451   // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5452   // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
5453   if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
5454     const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5455     const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
5456     S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
5457     if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5458       S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
5459     else {
5460       const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5461       S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5462     }
5463   }
5464   S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
5465 }
5466 
5467 // FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
5468 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5469                                             bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5470                                             bool ExpandStructures,
5471                                             const FieldDecl *FD,
5472                                             bool OutermostType,
5473                                             bool EncodingProperty,
5474                                             bool StructField,
5475                                             bool EncodeBlockParameters,
5476                                             bool EncodeClassNames,
5477                                             bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5478                                             QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
5479   CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5480   switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5481   case Type::Builtin:
5482   case Type::Enum:
5483     if (FD && FD->isBitField())
5484       return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
5485     if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5486       S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5487     else
5488       S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
5489     return;
5490 
5491   case Type::Complex: {
5492     const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
5493     S += 'j';
5494     getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
5495     return;
5496   }
5497 
5498   case Type::Atomic: {
5499     const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5500     S += 'A';
5501     getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
5502     return;
5503   }
5504 
5505   // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5506   case Type::Pointer:
5507   case Type::LValueReference:
5508   case Type::RValueReference: {
5509     QualType PointeeTy;
5510     if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5511       const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5512       if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5513         S += ':';
5514         return;
5515       }
5516       PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5517     } else {
5518       PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5519     }
5520 
5521     bool isReadOnly = false;
5522     // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5523     // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'.  The read-only qualifier of
5524     // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
5525     // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
5526     if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
5527       if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5528         isReadOnly = true;
5529         S += 'r';
5530       }
5531     } else if (OutermostType) {
5532       QualType P = PointeeTy;
5533       while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5534         P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5535       if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5536         isReadOnly = true;
5537         S += 'r';
5538       }
5539     }
5540     if (isReadOnly) {
5541       // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5542       // combinations need to be rearranged.
5543       // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
5544       if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
5545         S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
5546     }
5547 
5548     if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5549       // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5550       // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
5551       if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
5552         S += '*';
5553         return;
5554       }
5555     } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
5556       // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5557       if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5558         S += '#';
5559         return;
5560       }
5561       // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5562       if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5563         S += '@';
5564         return;
5565       }
5566       // fall through...
5567     }
5568     S += '^';
5569     getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5570 
5571     getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
5572                                nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
5573                                NotEncodedT);
5574     return;
5575   }
5576 
5577   case Type::ConstantArray:
5578   case Type::IncompleteArray:
5579   case Type::VariableArray: {
5580     const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5581 
5582     if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
5583       // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5584       S += '^';
5585 
5586       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
5587                                  false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5588     } else {
5589       S += '[';
5590 
5591       if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5592         S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5593       else {
5594         //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
5595         assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5596                "Unknown array type!");
5597         S += '0';
5598       }
5599 
5600       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
5601                                  false, ExpandStructures, FD,
5602                                  false, false, false, false, false, false,
5603                                  NotEncodedT);
5604       S += ']';
5605     }
5606     return;
5607   }
5608 
5609   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5610   case Type::FunctionProto:
5611     S += '?';
5612     return;
5613 
5614   case Type::Record: {
5615     RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
5616     S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
5617     // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5618     if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5619       S += II->getName();
5620       if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5621           = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5622         const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
5623         llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5624         TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
5625                                             TemplateArgs.data(),
5626                                             TemplateArgs.size(),
5627                                             (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
5628       }
5629     } else {
5630       S += '?';
5631     }
5632     if (ExpandStructures) {
5633       S += '=';
5634       if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5635         getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
5636       } else {
5637         for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
5638           if (FD) {
5639             S += '"';
5640             S += Field->getNameAsString();
5641             S += '"';
5642           }
5643 
5644           // Special case bit-fields.
5645           if (Field->isBitField()) {
5646             getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
5647                                        Field);
5648           } else {
5649             QualType qt = Field->getType();
5650             getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5651             getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5652                                        FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5653                                        /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5654                                        /*StructField*/true,
5655                                        false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
5656           }
5657         }
5658       }
5659     }
5660     S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
5661     return;
5662   }
5663 
5664   case Type::BlockPointer: {
5665     const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
5666     S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
5667     if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
5668       const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
5669 
5670       S += '<';
5671       // Block return type
5672       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5673           FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5674           FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5675           false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
5676                                  NotEncodedT);
5677       // Block self
5678       S += "@?";
5679       // Block parameters
5680       if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
5681         for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5682           getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5683               I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5684               false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5685               false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
5686                                      false, NotEncodedT);
5687       }
5688       S += '>';
5689     }
5690     return;
5691   }
5692 
5693   case Type::ObjCObject: {
5694     // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5695     QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5696     if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5697       S += "{objc_object=}";
5698       return;
5699     }
5700     else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5701       S += "{objc_class=}";
5702       return;
5703     }
5704   }
5705 
5706   case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5707     // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5708     // @encode(class_name)
5709     ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
5710     S += '{';
5711     S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5712     S += '=';
5713     SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5714     DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5715     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5716       const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
5717       if (Field->isBitField())
5718         getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
5719       else
5720         getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5721                                    false, false, false, false, false,
5722                                    EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5723                                    NotEncodedT);
5724     }
5725     S += '}';
5726     return;
5727   }
5728 
5729   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5730     const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5731     if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5732       S += '@';
5733       return;
5734     }
5735 
5736     if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5737       // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5738       // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5739       // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
5740       S += '#';
5741       return;
5742     }
5743 
5744     if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
5745       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
5746                                  ExpandPointedToStructures,
5747                                  ExpandStructures, FD);
5748       if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
5749         // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5750         // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
5751         S += '"';
5752         for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
5753           S += '<';
5754           S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5755           S += '>';
5756         }
5757         S += '"';
5758       }
5759       return;
5760     }
5761 
5762     QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5763     if (!EncodingProperty &&
5764         isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5765         !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
5766       // Another historical/compatibility reason.
5767       // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
5768       // {...};
5769       S += '^';
5770       if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
5771         // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
5772         ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5773         SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5774         DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5775         for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5776           if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5777             S += '{';
5778             S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5779             S += '}';
5780             return;
5781           }
5782         }
5783       }
5784       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5785                                  false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
5786                                  nullptr,
5787                                  false, false, false, false, false,
5788                                  /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
5789       return;
5790     }
5791 
5792     S += '@';
5793     if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5794         (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
5795       S += '"';
5796       S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5797       for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
5798         S += '<';
5799         S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5800         S += '>';
5801       }
5802       S += '"';
5803     }
5804     return;
5805   }
5806 
5807   // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
5808   // FIXME: we shoul do better than that.  'M' is available.
5809   case Type::MemberPointer:
5810   // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
5811   //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5812   case Type::Vector:
5813   case Type::ExtVector:
5814   // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
5815     { if (NotEncodedT)
5816         *NotEncodedT = T;
5817       return;
5818     }
5819 
5820   // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5821   // Just ignore it.
5822   case Type::Auto:
5823     return;
5824 
5825 
5826 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5827 #define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5828 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5829   case Type::KIND:
5830 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5831   case Type::KIND:
5832 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5833   case Type::KIND:
5834 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5835     llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
5836   }
5837   llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
5838 }
5839 
5840 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5841                                                  std::string &S,
5842                                                  const FieldDecl *FD,
5843                                                  bool includeVBases,
5844                                                  QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
5845   assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5846   assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5847   if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5848     return;
5849 
5850   CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5851   std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5852   const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5853 
5854   if (CXXRec) {
5855     for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5856       if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5857         CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
5858         if (base->isEmpty())
5859           continue;
5860         uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
5861         FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5862                                   std::make_pair(offs, base));
5863       }
5864     }
5865   }
5866 
5867   unsigned i = 0;
5868   for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
5869     uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5870     FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5871                               std::make_pair(offs, Field));
5872     ++i;
5873   }
5874 
5875   if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
5876     for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5877       CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
5878       if (base->isEmpty())
5879         continue;
5880       uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
5881       if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5882           FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
5883         FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5884                                   std::make_pair(offs, base));
5885     }
5886   }
5887 
5888   CharUnits size;
5889   if (CXXRec) {
5890     size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5891   } else {
5892     size = layout.getSize();
5893   }
5894 
5895 #ifndef NDEBUG
5896   uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
5897 #endif
5898   std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5899     CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5900 
5901   if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5902       (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
5903     if (FD) {
5904       S += "\"_vptr$";
5905       std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5906       if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5907       S += recname;
5908       S += '"';
5909     }
5910     S += "^^?";
5911 #ifndef NDEBUG
5912     CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
5913 #endif
5914   }
5915 
5916   if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5917     // Mark the end of the structure.
5918     uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5919     FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5920                               std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
5921   }
5922 
5923   for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
5924 #ifndef NDEBUG
5925     assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
5926     if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5927       uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5928       // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5929       // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5930       // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5931       // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5932       // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5933       // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5934       // longer then though.
5935       CurOffs += padding;
5936     }
5937 #endif
5938 
5939     NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
5940     if (!dcl)
5941       break; // reached end of structure.
5942 
5943     if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5944       // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5945       // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5946       // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5947       // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5948       getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
5949                                       NotEncodedT);
5950       assert(!base->isEmpty());
5951 #ifndef NDEBUG
5952       CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
5953 #endif
5954     } else {
5955       FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5956       if (FD) {
5957         S += '"';
5958         S += field->getNameAsString();
5959         S += '"';
5960       }
5961 
5962       if (field->isBitField()) {
5963         EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
5964 #ifndef NDEBUG
5965         CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
5966 #endif
5967       } else {
5968         QualType qt = field->getType();
5969         getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5970         getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5971                                    /*OutermostType*/false,
5972                                    /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5973                                    /*StructField*/true,
5974                                    false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
5975 #ifndef NDEBUG
5976         CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
5977 #endif
5978       }
5979     }
5980   }
5981 }
5982 
5983 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5984                                                  std::string& S) const {
5985   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5986     S += 'n';
5987   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5988     S += 'N';
5989   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5990     S += 'o';
5991   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5992     S += 'O';
5993   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5994     S += 'R';
5995   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5996     S += 'V';
5997 }
5998 
5999 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
6000   if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
6001     QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, { });
6002     T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
6003     ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
6004   }
6005   return ObjCIdDecl;
6006 }
6007 
6008 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
6009   if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
6010     QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
6011     ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
6012   }
6013   return ObjCSelDecl;
6014 }
6015 
6016 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
6017   if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
6018     QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, { });
6019     T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
6020     ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
6021   }
6022   return ObjCClassDecl;
6023 }
6024 
6025 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
6026   if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
6027     ObjCProtocolClassDecl
6028       = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6029                                   SourceLocation(),
6030                                   &Idents.get("Protocol"),
6031                                   /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
6032                                   /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
6033                                   SourceLocation(), true);
6034   }
6035 
6036   return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
6037 }
6038 
6039 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6040 // __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
6041 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6042 
6043 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6044                                                  StringRef Name) {
6045   // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
6046   QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
6047   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
6048 }
6049 
6050 static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6051   return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
6052 }
6053 
6054 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6055   return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
6056 }
6057 
6058 static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6059   // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
6060   QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6061   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
6062 }
6063 
6064 static TypedefDecl *
6065 CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6066   // struct __va_list
6067   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
6068   if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6069     // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6070     NamespaceDecl *NS;
6071     NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6072                                Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6073                                /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
6074                                SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
6075                                /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
6076     NS->setImplicit();
6077     VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
6078   }
6079 
6080   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6081 
6082   const size_t NumFields = 5;
6083   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6084   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6085 
6086   // void *__stack;
6087   FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6088   FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6089 
6090   // void *__gr_top;
6091   FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6092   FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6093 
6094   // void *__vr_top;
6095   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6096   FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6097 
6098   // int __gr_offs;
6099   FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6100   FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6101 
6102   // int __vr_offs;
6103   FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6104   FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6105 
6106   // Create fields
6107   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6108     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6109                                          VaListTagDecl,
6110                                          SourceLocation(),
6111                                          SourceLocation(),
6112                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6113                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6114                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6115                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
6116                                          ICIS_NoInit);
6117     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6118     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6119   }
6120   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6121   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
6122   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6123 
6124   // } __builtin_va_list;
6125   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
6126 }
6127 
6128 static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6129   // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6130   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6131 
6132   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
6133   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6134 
6135   const size_t NumFields = 5;
6136   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6137   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6138 
6139   //   unsigned char gpr;
6140   FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6141   FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6142 
6143   //   unsigned char fpr;
6144   FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6145   FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6146 
6147   //   unsigned short reserved;
6148   FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
6149   FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
6150 
6151   //   void* overflow_arg_area;
6152   FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6153   FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
6154 
6155   //   void* reg_save_area;
6156   FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6157   FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
6158 
6159   // Create fields
6160   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6161     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
6162                                          SourceLocation(),
6163                                          SourceLocation(),
6164                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6165                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6166                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6167                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
6168                                          ICIS_NoInit);
6169     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6170     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6171   }
6172   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6173   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
6174   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6175 
6176   // } __va_list_tag;
6177   TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6178       Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6179 
6180   QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6181     Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6182 
6183   // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6184   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6185   QualType VaListTagArrayType
6186     = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6187                                     Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6188   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6189 }
6190 
6191 static TypedefDecl *
6192 CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6193   // struct __va_list_tag {
6194   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6195   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
6196   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6197 
6198   const size_t NumFields = 4;
6199   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6200   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6201 
6202   //   unsigned gp_offset;
6203   FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6204   FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6205 
6206   //   unsigned fp_offset;
6207   FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6208   FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6209 
6210   //   void* overflow_arg_area;
6211   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6212   FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6213 
6214   //   void* reg_save_area;
6215   FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6216   FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6217 
6218   // Create fields
6219   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6220     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6221                                          VaListTagDecl,
6222                                          SourceLocation(),
6223                                          SourceLocation(),
6224                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6225                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6226                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6227                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
6228                                          ICIS_NoInit);
6229     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6230     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6231   }
6232   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6233   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
6234   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6235 
6236   // };
6237 
6238   // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6239   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6240   QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6241       Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6242   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6243 }
6244 
6245 static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6246   // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6247   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
6248   QualType IntArrayType
6249     = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
6250 				    Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6251   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6252 }
6253 
6254 static TypedefDecl *
6255 CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6256   // struct __va_list
6257   RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
6258   if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6259     // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6260     NamespaceDecl *NS;
6261     NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6262                                Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6263                                /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6264                                SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
6265                                /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
6266     NS->setImplicit();
6267     VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
6268   }
6269 
6270   VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6271 
6272   // void * __ap;
6273   FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6274                                        VaListDecl,
6275                                        SourceLocation(),
6276                                        SourceLocation(),
6277                                        &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6278                                        Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
6279                                        /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6280                                        /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6281                                        /*Mutable=*/false,
6282                                        ICIS_NoInit);
6283   Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6284   VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6285 
6286   // };
6287   VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6288 
6289   // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
6290   QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6291   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
6292 }
6293 
6294 static TypedefDecl *
6295 CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6296   // struct __va_list_tag {
6297   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6298   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
6299   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6300 
6301   const size_t NumFields = 4;
6302   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6303   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6304 
6305   //   long __gpr;
6306   FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6307   FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6308 
6309   //   long __fpr;
6310   FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6311   FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6312 
6313   //   void *__overflow_arg_area;
6314   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6315   FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6316 
6317   //   void *__reg_save_area;
6318   FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6319   FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6320 
6321   // Create fields
6322   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6323     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6324                                          VaListTagDecl,
6325                                          SourceLocation(),
6326                                          SourceLocation(),
6327                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6328                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6329                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6330                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
6331                                          ICIS_NoInit);
6332     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6333     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6334   }
6335   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6336   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
6337   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6338 
6339   // };
6340 
6341   // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6342   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6343   QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6344       Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6345 
6346   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6347 }
6348 
6349 static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6350                                      TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6351   switch (Kind) {
6352   case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6353     return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6354   case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6355     return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6356   case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6357     return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6358   case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6359     return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6360   case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6361     return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6362   case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6363     return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6364   case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6365     return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6366   case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6367     return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6368   }
6369 
6370   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6371 }
6372 
6373 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
6374   if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
6375     BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
6376     assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6377   }
6378 
6379   return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6380 }
6381 
6382 Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
6383   // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
6384   // declaration.
6385   if (!VaListTagDecl)
6386     (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6387 
6388   return VaListTagDecl;
6389 }
6390 
6391 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
6392   if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
6393     BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
6394 
6395   return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
6396 }
6397 
6398 void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
6399   assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
6400          "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
6401 
6402   ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
6403 }
6404 
6405 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6406 /// lookup.
6407 TemplateName
6408 ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6409                                       UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
6410   unsigned size = End - Begin;
6411   assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6412 
6413   void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6414                           size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6415   OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6416 
6417   NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
6418   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
6419     NamedDecl *D = *I;
6420     assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6421            (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6422             isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6423     *Storage++ = D;
6424   }
6425 
6426   return TemplateName(OT);
6427 }
6428 
6429 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6430 /// template name such as \c std::vector.
6431 TemplateName
6432 ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6433                                      bool TemplateKeyword,
6434                                      TemplateDecl *Template) const {
6435   assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6436 
6437   // FIXME: Canonicalization?
6438   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6439   QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6440 
6441   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6442   QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6443     QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6444   if (!QTN) {
6445     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6446         QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6447     QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6448   }
6449 
6450   return TemplateName(QTN);
6451 }
6452 
6453 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6454 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
6455 TemplateName
6456 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6457                                      const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
6458   assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6459          "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6460 
6461   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6462   DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6463 
6464   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6465   DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6466     DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6467 
6468   if (QTN)
6469     return TemplateName(QTN);
6470 
6471   NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6472   if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
6473     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6474         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
6475   } else {
6476     TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
6477     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6478         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
6479     DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6480       DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6481     assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6482     (void)CheckQTN;
6483   }
6484 
6485   DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6486   return TemplateName(QTN);
6487 }
6488 
6489 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6490 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6491 TemplateName
6492 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6493                                      OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
6494   assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6495          "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6496 
6497   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6498   DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
6499 
6500   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6501   DependentTemplateName *QTN
6502     = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6503 
6504   if (QTN)
6505     return TemplateName(QTN);
6506 
6507   NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6508   if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
6509     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6510         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
6511   } else {
6512     TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
6513     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6514         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
6515 
6516     DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6517       = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6518     assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6519     (void)CheckQTN;
6520   }
6521 
6522   DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6523   return TemplateName(QTN);
6524 }
6525 
6526 TemplateName
6527 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6528                                          TemplateName replacement) const {
6529   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6530   SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
6531 
6532   void *insertPos = nullptr;
6533   SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6534     = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6535 
6536   if (!subst) {
6537     subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6538     SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6539   }
6540 
6541   return TemplateName(subst);
6542 }
6543 
6544 TemplateName
6545 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6546                                        const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6547   ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6548   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6549   SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
6550 
6551   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6552   SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6553     = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6554 
6555   if (!Subst) {
6556     Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
6557                                                            ArgPack.pack_size(),
6558                                                          ArgPack.pack_begin());
6559     SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6560   }
6561 
6562   return TemplateName(Subst);
6563 }
6564 
6565 /// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
6566 /// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6567 /// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
6568 CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
6569   switch (Type) {
6570   case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
6571   case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6572   case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
6573   case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6574   case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6575   case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6576   case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6577   case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6578   case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6579   case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6580   case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6581   }
6582 
6583   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
6584 }
6585 
6586 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6587 //                        Type Predicates.
6588 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6589 
6590 /// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6591 /// garbage collection attribute.
6592 ///
6593 Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
6594   if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
6595     return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6596 
6597   assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
6598   Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6599 
6600   // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6601   // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6602   // as __strong.
6603   if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6604     if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6605       return Qualifiers::Strong;
6606     else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6607       return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6608   } else {
6609     // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6610     // pointer.
6611 #ifndef NDEBUG
6612     QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6613     while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6614       CT = AT->getElementType();
6615     assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6616 #endif
6617   }
6618   return GCAttrs;
6619 }
6620 
6621 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6622 //                        Type Compatibility Testing
6623 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6624 
6625 /// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
6626 /// compatible.
6627 static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6628                                  const VectorType *RHS) {
6629   assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
6630   return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
6631          LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
6632 }
6633 
6634 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6635                                           QualType SecondVec) {
6636   assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6637   assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6638 
6639   if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6640     return true;
6641 
6642   // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6643   // equivalent GCC vector types.
6644   const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6645   const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6646   if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
6647       hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
6648       First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6649       First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6650       Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6651       Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
6652     return true;
6653 
6654   return false;
6655 }
6656 
6657 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6658 // ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6659 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6660 
6661 /// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6662 /// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
6663 bool
6664 ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6665                                            ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
6666   if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
6667     return true;
6668   for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6669     if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
6670       return true;
6671   return false;
6672 }
6673 
6674 /// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare  Class<pr,...> and
6675 /// Class<pr1, ...>.
6676 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6677                                                       QualType rhs) {
6678   const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6679   const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6680   assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6681 
6682   for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
6683     bool match = false;
6684     for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
6685       if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6686         match = true;
6687         break;
6688       }
6689     }
6690     if (!match)
6691       return false;
6692   }
6693   return true;
6694 }
6695 
6696 /// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6697 /// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6698 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6699                                                    bool compare) {
6700   // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
6701   if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
6702       lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6703     return true;
6704   else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
6705            rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6706     return true;
6707 
6708   if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
6709     const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6710 
6711     if (!rhsOPT) return false;
6712 
6713     if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
6714       // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
6715       // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6716       if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6717         for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
6718           // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6719           // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6720           // through its super class and categories.
6721           if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
6722             return false;
6723         }
6724       }
6725       // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6726       return true;
6727     }
6728     // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
6729     for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
6730       bool match = false;
6731 
6732       // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6733       // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6734       // through its super class and categories.
6735       for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
6736         if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6737             (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6738           match = true;
6739           break;
6740         }
6741       }
6742       // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
6743       // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6744       if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6745         for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
6746           // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6747           // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6748           // through its super class and categories.
6749           if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
6750             match = true;
6751             break;
6752           }
6753         }
6754       }
6755       if (!match)
6756         return false;
6757     }
6758 
6759     return true;
6760   }
6761 
6762   const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6763   assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6764 
6765   if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
6766         lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
6767     // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
6768     for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
6769       bool match = false;
6770 
6771       // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
6772       // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6773       // through its super class and categories.
6774       // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6775       // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6776       for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
6777         if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6778             (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6779           match = true;
6780           break;
6781         }
6782       }
6783       if (!match)
6784         return false;
6785     }
6786 
6787     // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6788     // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6789     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6790       llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6791       CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6792       // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6793       // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6794       // assume that it is mismatch.
6795       if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6796         return false;
6797       for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
6798         bool match = false;
6799         for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
6800           if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6801               (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6802             match = true;
6803             break;
6804           }
6805         }
6806         if (!match)
6807           return false;
6808       }
6809     }
6810     return true;
6811   }
6812   return false;
6813 }
6814 
6815 /// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
6816 /// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS.  This handles validation of any
6817 /// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6818 ///
6819 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6820                                          const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
6821   const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6822   const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6823 
6824   // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
6825   if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6826       RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
6827     return true;
6828 
6829   // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6830   // __kindof types.
6831   auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
6832     if (succeeded)
6833       return true;
6834 
6835     if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
6836       return false;
6837 
6838     // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
6839     // we can assign the other way.
6840     return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6841                                    LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
6842   };
6843 
6844   if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
6845     return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6846                                                     QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6847                                                     false));
6848   }
6849 
6850   if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
6851     return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6852                                                        QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
6853   }
6854 
6855   // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6856   if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
6857     return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
6858   }
6859 
6860   return false;
6861 }
6862 
6863 /// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
6864 /// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
6865 /// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6866 /// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6867 /// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6868 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6869                                          const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6870                                          const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6871                                          bool BlockReturnType) {
6872 
6873   // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6874   // __kindof types.
6875   auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
6876     if (succeeded)
6877       return true;
6878 
6879     const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
6880     if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
6881       return false;
6882 
6883     // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
6884     // we can assign the other way.
6885     return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6886              RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6887              LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6888              BlockReturnType);
6889   };
6890 
6891   if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
6892     return true;
6893 
6894   if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6895     return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
6896                   RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
6897   }
6898 
6899   if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6900     return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6901                                                     QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6902                                                     false));
6903 
6904   const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6905   const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6906   if (LHS && RHS)  { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6907     if (LHS != RHS) {
6908       if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
6909         return finish(BlockReturnType);
6910       if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
6911         return finish(!BlockReturnType);
6912     }
6913     else
6914       return true;
6915   }
6916   return false;
6917 }
6918 
6919 /// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
6920 /// llvm::array_pod_sort.
6921 static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
6922                                       ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
6923   return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
6924 
6925 }
6926 
6927 /// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6928 /// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
6929 /// the given common base.
6930 /// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6931 /// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6932 static
6933 void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6934                                 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
6935                                 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6936                                 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6937       SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
6938 
6939   const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6940   const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6941   assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6942   assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
6943 
6944   // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
6945   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
6946 
6947   // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
6948   for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
6949     Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
6950   }
6951 
6952   // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
6953   Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
6954 
6955   // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
6956   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
6957 
6958   // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
6959   for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
6960     Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
6961   }
6962 
6963   // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
6964   Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
6965 
6966   // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
6967   for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
6968     if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
6969       IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
6970   }
6971 
6972   // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
6973   // the protocols within the intersection.
6974   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
6975   Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
6976 
6977   // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
6978   if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
6979     IntersectionSet.erase(
6980       std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
6981                      IntersectionSet.end(),
6982                      [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
6983                        return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
6984                      }),
6985       IntersectionSet.end());
6986   }
6987 
6988   // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
6989   llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
6990                        compareObjCProtocolsByName);
6991 }
6992 
6993 /// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
6994 static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
6995                                      QualType rhs) {
6996   // Common case: two object pointers.
6997   const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6998   const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6999   if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
7000     return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
7001 
7002   // Two block pointers.
7003   const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7004   const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7005   if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
7006     return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
7007 
7008   // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
7009   // acceptable.
7010   if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
7011       (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
7012     return true;
7013 
7014   return false;
7015 }
7016 
7017 // Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
7018 static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
7019                              const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
7020                              ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
7021                              ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
7022                              bool stripKindOf) {
7023   if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
7024     return false;
7025 
7026   ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
7027   for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
7028     if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7029       continue;
7030 
7031     switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
7032     case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
7033       if (!stripKindOf ||
7034           !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
7035                            rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
7036         return false;
7037       }
7038       break;
7039 
7040     case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
7041       if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7042         return false;
7043       break;
7044 
7045     case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
7046       if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7047         return false;
7048       break;
7049     }
7050   }
7051 
7052   return true;
7053 }
7054 
7055 QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
7056            const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7057            const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
7058   const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7059   const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7060   const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7061   const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
7062 
7063   if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
7064     return QualType();
7065 
7066   // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7067   // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7068   llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7069     LHSAncestors;
7070   while (true) {
7071     // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7072     // path from the LHS to the root.
7073     LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
7074 
7075     if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7076       // Get the type arguments.
7077       ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7078       bool anyChanges = false;
7079       if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7080         // Both have type arguments, compare them.
7081         if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7082                               LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
7083                               /*stripKindOf=*/true))
7084           return QualType();
7085       } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7086         // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7087         // arguments.
7088         LHSTypeArgs = { };
7089         anyChanges = true;
7090       }
7091 
7092       // Compute the intersection of protocols.
7093       SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
7094       getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7095                                  Protocols);
7096       if (!Protocols.empty())
7097         anyChanges = true;
7098 
7099       // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
7100       if (anyChanges) {
7101         QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
7102         Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
7103                                    LHS->isKindOfType());
7104         return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7105       }
7106 
7107       return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
7108     }
7109 
7110     // Find the superclass.
7111     QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7112     if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7113       break;
7114 
7115     LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7116   }
7117 
7118   // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7119   // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7120   while (true) {
7121     auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7122     if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7123       LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7124 
7125       // Get the type arguments.
7126       ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7127       bool anyChanges = false;
7128       if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7129         // Both have type arguments, compare them.
7130         if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7131                               LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
7132                               /*stripKindOf=*/true))
7133           return QualType();
7134       } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7135         // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7136         // arguments.
7137         RHSTypeArgs = { };
7138         anyChanges = true;
7139       }
7140 
7141       // Compute the intersection of protocols.
7142       SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
7143       getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7144                                  Protocols);
7145       if (!Protocols.empty())
7146         anyChanges = true;
7147 
7148       if (anyChanges) {
7149         QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
7150         Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
7151                                    RHS->isKindOfType());
7152         return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7153       }
7154 
7155       return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
7156     }
7157 
7158     // Find the superclass of the RHS.
7159     QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
7160     if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
7161       break;
7162 
7163     RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7164   }
7165 
7166   return QualType();
7167 }
7168 
7169 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
7170                                          const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
7171   assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
7172   assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
7173 
7174   // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
7175   // the LHS.
7176   ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
7177   bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
7178   if (!IsSuperClass)
7179     return false;
7180 
7181   // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
7182   // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
7183   // LHS).
7184   if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
7185     // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
7186     // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
7187     // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
7188     // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
7189     llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
7190     CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
7191     // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
7192     // qualifiers.
7193     for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
7194       CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
7195     // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
7196     if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
7197       return false;
7198 
7199     for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
7200       bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
7201       for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
7202         if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
7203           SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
7204           break;
7205         }
7206       if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
7207         return false;
7208     }
7209   }
7210 
7211   // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
7212   if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
7213     // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
7214     // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
7215     const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
7216     while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
7217       RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7218 
7219     // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
7220     if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
7221         !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7222                           LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
7223                           /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
7224       return false;
7225     }
7226   }
7227 
7228   return true;
7229 }
7230 
7231 bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7232   // get the "pointed to" types
7233   const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7234   const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7235 
7236   if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
7237     return false;
7238 
7239   return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
7240          canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
7241 }
7242 
7243 bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
7244   return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
7245                 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7246                 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
7247 }
7248 
7249 /// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
7250 /// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
7251 /// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
7252 /// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
7253 bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7254                                     bool CompareUnqualified) {
7255   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
7256     return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
7257 
7258   return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
7259 }
7260 
7261 bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7262   return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
7263 }
7264 
7265 bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7266   return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
7267 }
7268 
7269 /// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
7270 /// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
7271 /// QualType()
7272 QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
7273                                                bool OfBlockPointer,
7274                                                bool Unqualified) {
7275   if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
7276     RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
7277     if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
7278       for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
7279         QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7280         QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7281         if (!MT.isNull())
7282           return MT;
7283       }
7284     }
7285   }
7286 
7287   return QualType();
7288 }
7289 
7290 /// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
7291 /// parameter types
7292 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7293                                                  bool OfBlockPointer,
7294                                                  bool Unqualified) {
7295   // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
7296   // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
7297   // type is compatible with a union member
7298   QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
7299                                               Unqualified);
7300   if (!lmerge.isNull())
7301     return lmerge;
7302 
7303   QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
7304                                               Unqualified);
7305   if (!rmerge.isNull())
7306     return rmerge;
7307 
7308   return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7309 }
7310 
7311 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7312                                         bool OfBlockPointer,
7313                                         bool Unqualified) {
7314   const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7315   const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7316   const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
7317   const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
7318   bool allLTypes = true;
7319   bool allRTypes = true;
7320 
7321   // Check return type
7322   QualType retType;
7323   if (OfBlockPointer) {
7324     QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
7325     QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
7326     bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
7327     if (!UnqualifiedResult)
7328       UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
7329     retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
7330   }
7331   else
7332     retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
7333                          Unqualified);
7334   if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
7335 
7336   if (Unqualified)
7337     retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
7338 
7339   CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
7340   CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
7341   if (Unqualified) {
7342     LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7343     RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7344   }
7345 
7346   if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
7347     allLTypes = false;
7348   if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
7349     allRTypes = false;
7350 
7351   // FIXME: double check this
7352   // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7353   //                           rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7354   //                           lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
7355   FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7356   FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
7357 
7358   // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
7359   if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
7360     return QualType();
7361 
7362   // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
7363   if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7364     return QualType();
7365   if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7366     return QualType();
7367 
7368   if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7369     return QualType();
7370 
7371   // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7372   bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
7373 
7374   if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7375     allLTypes = false;
7376   if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7377     allRTypes = false;
7378 
7379   FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
7380 
7381   if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
7382     assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7383            "C++ shouldn't be here");
7384     // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
7385     if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
7386       return QualType();
7387 
7388     // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7389     if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7390       return QualType();
7391 
7392     if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7393       return QualType();
7394 
7395     if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
7396         !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
7397       return QualType();
7398 
7399     // Check parameter type compatibility
7400     SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
7401     for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7402       QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7403       QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7404       QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7405           lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7406       if (paramType.isNull())
7407         return QualType();
7408 
7409       if (Unqualified)
7410         paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7411 
7412       types.push_back(paramType);
7413       if (Unqualified) {
7414         lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7415         rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7416       }
7417 
7418       if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
7419         allLTypes = false;
7420       if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
7421         allRTypes = false;
7422     }
7423 
7424     if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7425     if (allRTypes) return rhs;
7426 
7427     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7428     EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
7429     return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
7430   }
7431 
7432   if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7433   if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7434 
7435   const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
7436   if (proto) {
7437     assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
7438     if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7439     // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7440     // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7441     // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7442     // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7443     // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
7444     for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7445       QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
7446 
7447       // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
7448       // to pass enum values.
7449       if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7450         paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7451         if (paramTy.isNull())
7452           return QualType();
7453       }
7454 
7455       if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7456           getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
7457         return QualType();
7458     }
7459 
7460     if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7461     if (allRTypes) return rhs;
7462 
7463     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7464     EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
7465     return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
7466   }
7467 
7468   if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7469   if (allRTypes) return rhs;
7470   return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
7471 }
7472 
7473 /// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7474 static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7475                                      QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7476   // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7477   // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7478   // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7479   // type.
7480   QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7481   if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7482   if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7483     return other;
7484 
7485   // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7486   // integral type of the same size.
7487   if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7488       Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7489     return other;
7490 
7491   return QualType();
7492 }
7493 
7494 QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7495                                 bool OfBlockPointer,
7496                                 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
7497   // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7498   // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7499   // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
7500   // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7501   // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
7502   assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7503   assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
7504 
7505   if (Unqualified) {
7506     LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7507     RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7508   }
7509 
7510   QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7511            RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7512 
7513   // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7514   if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7515     return LHS;
7516 
7517   // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
7518   Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7519   Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7520   if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7521     // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7522     // mismatch.
7523     if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7524         LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7525         LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
7526       return QualType();
7527 
7528     // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7529     // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7530     // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default).  We fix
7531     // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7532     // qualified __strong.
7533     Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7534     Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7535     assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7536 
7537     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7538       return QualType();
7539 
7540     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7541       return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7542     }
7543     if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7544       return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7545     }
7546     return QualType();
7547   }
7548 
7549   // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
7550 
7551   Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7552   Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
7553 
7554   // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7555   // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7556   if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7557   if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7558 
7559   // Same as above for arrays
7560   if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7561     LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7562   if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7563     RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7564 
7565   // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7566   if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7567   if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7568 
7569   // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7570   if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7571   if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
7572 
7573   // If the canonical type classes don't match.
7574   if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
7575     // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7576     // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
7577     if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7578       return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
7579     }
7580     if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7581       return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
7582     }
7583     // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
7584     if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7585        if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7586          return LHS;
7587       if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7588         return RHS;
7589     }
7590 
7591     return QualType();
7592   }
7593 
7594   // The canonical type classes match.
7595   switch (LHSClass) {
7596 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
7597 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
7598 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7599 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7600 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7601 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
7602     llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
7603 
7604   case Type::Auto:
7605   case Type::LValueReference:
7606   case Type::RValueReference:
7607   case Type::MemberPointer:
7608     llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
7609 
7610   case Type::ObjCInterface:
7611   case Type::IncompleteArray:
7612   case Type::VariableArray:
7613   case Type::FunctionProto:
7614   case Type::ExtVector:
7615     llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
7616 
7617   case Type::Pointer:
7618   {
7619     // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7620     QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7621     QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7622     if (Unqualified) {
7623       LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7624       RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7625     }
7626     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7627                                      Unqualified);
7628     if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7629     if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7630       return LHS;
7631     if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7632       return RHS;
7633     return getPointerType(ResultType);
7634   }
7635   case Type::BlockPointer:
7636   {
7637     // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7638     QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7639     QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7640     if (Unqualified) {
7641       LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7642       RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7643     }
7644     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7645                                      Unqualified);
7646     if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7647     if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7648       return LHS;
7649     if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7650       return RHS;
7651     return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7652   }
7653   case Type::Atomic:
7654   {
7655     // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7656     QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7657     QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7658     if (Unqualified) {
7659       LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7660       RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7661     }
7662     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7663                                      Unqualified);
7664     if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7665     if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7666       return LHS;
7667     if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7668       return RHS;
7669     return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7670   }
7671   case Type::ConstantArray:
7672   {
7673     const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7674     const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7675     if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7676       return QualType();
7677 
7678     QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7679     QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
7680     if (Unqualified) {
7681       LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7682       RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7683     }
7684 
7685     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
7686     if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7687     if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7688       return LHS;
7689     if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7690       return RHS;
7691     if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7692                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7693     if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7694                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7695     const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7696     const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
7697     if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7698       return LHS;
7699     if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7700       return RHS;
7701     if (LVAT) {
7702       // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7703       // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7704       // has to be different.
7705       return LHS;
7706     }
7707     if (RVAT) {
7708       // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7709       // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7710       // has to be different.
7711       return RHS;
7712     }
7713     if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7714     if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
7715     return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7716                                   ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7717   }
7718   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
7719     return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7720   case Type::Record:
7721   case Type::Enum:
7722     return QualType();
7723   case Type::Builtin:
7724     // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
7725     return QualType();
7726   case Type::Complex:
7727     // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7728     return QualType();
7729   case Type::Vector:
7730     // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
7731     if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7732                              RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
7733       return LHS;
7734     return QualType();
7735   case Type::ObjCObject: {
7736     // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
7737     // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7738     // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
7739     const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7740     const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7741     if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
7742       return LHS;
7743 
7744     return QualType();
7745   }
7746   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
7747     if (OfBlockPointer) {
7748       if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7749                                           LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7750                                           RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7751                                           BlockReturnType))
7752         return LHS;
7753       return QualType();
7754     }
7755     if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7756                                 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
7757       return LHS;
7758 
7759     return QualType();
7760   }
7761   }
7762 
7763   llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
7764 }
7765 
7766 bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7767                    const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7768                    const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
7769   if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7770       ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
7771     return false;
7772   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7773     FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7774   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7775     ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7776   if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
7777     for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7778       if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
7779         return false;
7780     }
7781   return true;
7782 }
7783 
7784 /// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7785 /// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7786 /// return types.
7787 QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7788   QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7789   RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7790   // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7791   if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7792     return LHS;
7793   if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7794     if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7795       return QualType();
7796     QualType OldReturnType =
7797         cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
7798     QualType NewReturnType =
7799         cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
7800     QualType ResReturnType =
7801       mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7802     if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7803       return QualType();
7804     if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7805       // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7806       // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7807       const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7808       if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
7809         FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7810         EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
7811         QualType ResultType =
7812             getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
7813         return ResultType;
7814       }
7815     }
7816     return QualType();
7817   }
7818 
7819   // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7820   Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7821   Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7822   if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7823     // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7824     if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7825         LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7826       return QualType();
7827 
7828     // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7829     // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7830     // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default).  We fix
7831     // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7832     // qualified __strong.
7833     Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7834     Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7835     assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7836 
7837     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7838       return QualType();
7839 
7840     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7841       return LHS;
7842     if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7843       return RHS;
7844     return QualType();
7845   }
7846 
7847   if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7848     QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7849     QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7850     QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7851     if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7852       return LHS;
7853     if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7854       return RHS;
7855   }
7856   return QualType();
7857 }
7858 
7859 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7860 //                         Integer Predicates
7861 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7862 
7863 unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
7864   if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7865     T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7866   if (T->isBooleanType())
7867     return 1;
7868   // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
7869   return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7870 }
7871 
7872 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
7873   assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
7874 
7875   // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7876   if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7877     return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
7878                          VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
7879 
7880   // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7881   if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7882     T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7883 
7884   const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7885   assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
7886   switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7887   case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7888   case BuiltinType::SChar:
7889     return UnsignedCharTy;
7890   case BuiltinType::Short:
7891     return UnsignedShortTy;
7892   case BuiltinType::Int:
7893     return UnsignedIntTy;
7894   case BuiltinType::Long:
7895     return UnsignedLongTy;
7896   case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7897     return UnsignedLongLongTy;
7898   case BuiltinType::Int128:
7899     return UnsignedInt128Ty;
7900   default:
7901     llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
7902   }
7903 }
7904 
7905 ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7906 
7907 void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7908                                             QualType ReturnType) {}
7909 
7910 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7911 //                          Builtin Type Computation
7912 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7913 
7914 /// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
7915 /// pointer over the consumed characters.  This returns the resultant type.  If
7916 /// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7917 /// types.  This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7918 /// a vector of "i*".
7919 ///
7920 /// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7921 /// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
7922 static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
7923                                   ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
7924                                   bool &RequiresICE,
7925                                   bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
7926   // Modifiers.
7927   int HowLong = 0;
7928   bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
7929   RequiresICE = false;
7930 
7931   // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
7932   bool Done = false;
7933   while (!Done) {
7934     switch (*Str++) {
7935     default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7936     case 'I':
7937       RequiresICE = true;
7938       break;
7939     case 'S':
7940       assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7941       assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7942       Signed = true;
7943       break;
7944     case 'U':
7945       assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7946       assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
7947       Unsigned = true;
7948       break;
7949     case 'L':
7950       assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7951       ++HowLong;
7952       break;
7953     case 'W':
7954       // This modifier represents int64 type.
7955       assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7956       switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7957       default:
7958         llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7959       case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7960         HowLong = 1;
7961         break;
7962       case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7963         HowLong = 2;
7964         break;
7965       }
7966     }
7967   }
7968 
7969   QualType Type;
7970 
7971   // Read the base type.
7972   switch (*Str++) {
7973   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
7974   case 'v':
7975     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7976            "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7977     Type = Context.VoidTy;
7978     break;
7979   case 'h':
7980     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7981            "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
7982     Type = Context.HalfTy;
7983     break;
7984   case 'f':
7985     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7986            "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7987     Type = Context.FloatTy;
7988     break;
7989   case 'd':
7990     assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7991            "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7992     if (HowLong)
7993       Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7994     else
7995       Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7996     break;
7997   case 's':
7998     assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7999     if (Unsigned)
8000       Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
8001     else
8002       Type = Context.ShortTy;
8003     break;
8004   case 'i':
8005     if (HowLong == 3)
8006       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
8007     else if (HowLong == 2)
8008       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
8009     else if (HowLong == 1)
8010       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
8011     else
8012       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
8013     break;
8014   case 'c':
8015     assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
8016     if (Signed)
8017       Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
8018     else if (Unsigned)
8019       Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
8020     else
8021       Type = Context.CharTy;
8022     break;
8023   case 'b': // boolean
8024     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
8025     Type = Context.BoolTy;
8026     break;
8027   case 'z':  // size_t.
8028     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
8029     Type = Context.getSizeType();
8030     break;
8031   case 'F':
8032     Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
8033     break;
8034   case 'G':
8035     Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
8036     break;
8037   case 'H':
8038     Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
8039     break;
8040   case 'M':
8041     Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
8042     break;
8043   case 'a':
8044     Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8045     assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8046     break;
8047   case 'A':
8048     // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
8049     // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
8050     // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
8051     // passed by reference.  An example of a by-value va_list is
8052     // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
8053     // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
8054     // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
8055     // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
8056     Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8057     assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8058     if (Type->isArrayType())
8059       Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
8060     else
8061       Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
8062     break;
8063   case 'V': {
8064     char *End;
8065     unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8066     assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
8067     Str = End;
8068 
8069     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
8070                                              RequiresICE, false);
8071     assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
8072 
8073     // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
8074     Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
8075                                  VectorType::GenericVector);
8076     break;
8077   }
8078   case 'E': {
8079     char *End;
8080 
8081     unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8082     assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
8083 
8084     Str = End;
8085 
8086     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8087                                              false);
8088     Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
8089     break;
8090   }
8091   case 'X': {
8092     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8093                                              false);
8094     assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
8095     Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
8096     break;
8097   }
8098   case 'Y' : {
8099     Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
8100     break;
8101   }
8102   case 'P':
8103     Type = Context.getFILEType();
8104     if (Type.isNull()) {
8105       Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
8106       return QualType();
8107     }
8108     break;
8109   case 'J':
8110     if (Signed)
8111       Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
8112     else
8113       Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
8114 
8115     if (Type.isNull()) {
8116       Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
8117       return QualType();
8118     }
8119     break;
8120   case 'K':
8121     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
8122     Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
8123 
8124     if (Type.isNull()) {
8125       Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
8126       return QualType();
8127     }
8128     break;
8129   case 'p':
8130     Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
8131     break;
8132   }
8133 
8134   // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
8135   Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
8136   while (!Done) {
8137     switch (char c = *Str++) {
8138     default: Done = true; --Str; break;
8139     case '*':
8140     case '&': {
8141       // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
8142       // qualified with an address space.
8143       char *End;
8144       unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8145       if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
8146         Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
8147         Str = End;
8148       }
8149       if (c == '*')
8150         Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
8151       else
8152         Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
8153       break;
8154     }
8155     // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
8156     case 'C':
8157       Type = Type.withConst();
8158       break;
8159     case 'D':
8160       Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
8161       break;
8162     case 'R':
8163       Type = Type.withRestrict();
8164       break;
8165     }
8166   }
8167 
8168   assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
8169          "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
8170 
8171   return Type;
8172 }
8173 
8174 /// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
8175 QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
8176                                     GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
8177                                     unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
8178   const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
8179 
8180   SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
8181 
8182   bool RequiresICE = false;
8183   Error = GE_None;
8184   QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
8185                                        RequiresICE, true);
8186   if (Error != GE_None)
8187     return QualType();
8188 
8189   assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
8190 
8191   while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
8192     QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
8193     if (Error != GE_None)
8194       return QualType();
8195 
8196     // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
8197     // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
8198     if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
8199       *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
8200 
8201     // Do array -> pointer decay.  The builtin should use the decayed type.
8202     if (Ty->isArrayType())
8203       Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
8204 
8205     ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
8206   }
8207 
8208   if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
8209     return QualType();
8210 
8211   assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
8212          "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
8213 
8214   FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
8215   if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
8216 
8217   bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
8218 
8219   // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
8220   if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
8221     return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
8222 
8223   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
8224   EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
8225   EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
8226 
8227   return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
8228 }
8229 
8230 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
8231                                              const FunctionDecl *FD) {
8232   if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
8233     return GVA_Internal;
8234 
8235   GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8236   switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
8237   case TSK_Undeclared:
8238   case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8239     External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8240     break;
8241 
8242   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
8243     return GVA_StrongODR;
8244 
8245   // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
8246   //   [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
8247   //   an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
8248   //   instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
8249   //   inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
8250   //   generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
8251   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8252     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8253 
8254   case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
8255     External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
8256     break;
8257   }
8258 
8259   if (!FD->isInlined())
8260     return External;
8261 
8262   if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
8263        !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
8264       FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
8265     // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
8266 
8267     // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
8268     // externally visible.
8269     if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
8270       return External;
8271 
8272     // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
8273     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8274   }
8275 
8276   // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
8277   // forcibly get emitted.  While the body of the function cannot be later
8278   // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
8279   if (FD->isMSExternInline())
8280     return GVA_StrongODR;
8281 
8282   return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8283 }
8284 
8285 static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
8286   // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
8287   // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
8288   if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
8289     if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
8290       return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8291   } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
8292     if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8293       return GVA_StrongODR;
8294   }
8295   return L;
8296 }
8297 
8298 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
8299   return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
8300                                          FD);
8301 }
8302 
8303 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
8304                                              const VarDecl *VD) {
8305   if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
8306     return GVA_Internal;
8307 
8308   if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
8309     GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
8310     const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
8311     while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
8312       LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
8313 
8314     // Let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the nearest
8315     // enclosing function.
8316     if (LexicalContext)
8317       StaticLocalLinkage =
8318           Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
8319 
8320     // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
8321     // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
8322     // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
8323     return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
8324                                                : StaticLocalLinkage;
8325   }
8326 
8327   // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
8328   // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
8329   // cause link errors.
8330   if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8331     return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8332 
8333   switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
8334   case TSK_Undeclared:
8335     return GVA_StrongExternal;
8336 
8337   case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8338     return Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember()
8339                ? GVA_StrongODR
8340                : GVA_StrongExternal;
8341 
8342   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
8343     return GVA_StrongODR;
8344 
8345   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8346     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8347 
8348   case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
8349     return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8350   }
8351 
8352   llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
8353 }
8354 
8355 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
8356   return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
8357                                          VD);
8358 }
8359 
8360 bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
8361   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8362     if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
8363       return false;
8364     // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
8365     if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
8366       return false;
8367     if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
8368         isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
8369       return false;
8370   } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8371     // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
8372     if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
8373       return false;
8374   } else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
8375     return true;
8376   else
8377     return false;
8378 
8379   // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
8380   if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
8381     return false;
8382 
8383   // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
8384   if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
8385     return false;
8386 
8387   // Aliases and used decls are required.
8388   if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
8389     return true;
8390 
8391   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8392     // Forward declarations aren't required.
8393     if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
8394       return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
8395 
8396     // Constructors and destructors are required.
8397     if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
8398       return true;
8399 
8400     // The key function for a class is required.  This rule only comes
8401     // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
8402     if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
8403       if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8404         const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
8405         if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
8406           const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
8407           if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8408             return true;
8409         }
8410       }
8411     }
8412 
8413     GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
8414 
8415     // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8416     // always be deferred.  Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8417     // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
8418     if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
8419         Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8420       return false;
8421     return true;
8422   }
8423 
8424   const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8425   assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8426 
8427   if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
8428       !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8429     return false;
8430 
8431   // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
8432   GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
8433   if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
8434       L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
8435     return true;
8436 
8437   // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8438   if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8439     return true;
8440 
8441   // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
8442   if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
8443       !VD->evaluateValue())
8444     return true;
8445 
8446   return false;
8447 }
8448 
8449 CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8450                                                     bool IsCXXMethod) const {
8451   // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8452   if (IsCXXMethod)
8453     return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
8454 
8455   if (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) return CC_X86StdCall;
8456 
8457   return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
8458 }
8459 
8460 bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
8461   // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8462   return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
8463 }
8464 
8465 VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
8466   if (!VTContext.get()) {
8467     if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
8468       VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
8469     else
8470       VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
8471   }
8472   return VTContext.get();
8473 }
8474 
8475 MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
8476   switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
8477   case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
8478   case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8479   case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
8480   case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
8481   case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
8482   case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
8483   case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
8484     return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
8485   case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
8486     return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
8487   }
8488   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
8489 }
8490 
8491 CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
8492 
8493 size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
8494   return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8495          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8496          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8497          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8498          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8499          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8500          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8501          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8502          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8503          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8504          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8505          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8506          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8507          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
8508 }
8509 
8510 /// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8511 /// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8512 /// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8513 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8514 QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8515                                            unsigned Signed) const {
8516   TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8517   CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8518   if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8519     return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8520   return QualTy;
8521 }
8522 
8523 /// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8524 /// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8525 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8526 QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8527   TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8528   switch (Ty) {
8529   case TargetInfo::Float:
8530     return FloatTy;
8531   case TargetInfo::Double:
8532     return DoubleTy;
8533   case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8534     return LongDoubleTy;
8535   case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8536     return QualType();
8537   }
8538 
8539   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8540 }
8541 
8542 void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8543   if (Number > 1)
8544     MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
8545 }
8546 
8547 unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8548   llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8549     MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8550   return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8551 }
8552 
8553 void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8554   if (Number > 1)
8555     StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8556 }
8557 
8558 unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8559   llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8560       StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8561   return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8562 }
8563 
8564 MangleNumberingContext &
8565 ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
8566   assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus);  // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8567   MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8568   if (!MCtx)
8569     MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8570   return *MCtx;
8571 }
8572 
8573 MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8574   return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
8575 }
8576 
8577 const CXXConstructorDecl *
8578 ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
8579   return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8580       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
8581 }
8582 
8583 void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
8584                                                       CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
8585   return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8586       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
8587       cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
8588 }
8589 
8590 void ASTContext::addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8591                                                  unsigned ParmIdx, Expr *DAE) {
8592   ABI->addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8593       cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx, DAE);
8594 }
8595 
8596 Expr *ASTContext::getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8597                                                   unsigned ParmIdx) {
8598   return ABI->getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8599       cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx);
8600 }
8601 
8602 void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
8603                                                  TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
8604   return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
8605 }
8606 
8607 TypedefNameDecl *
8608 ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
8609   return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
8610 }
8611 
8612 void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
8613                                                 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
8614   return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
8615 }
8616 
8617 DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
8618   return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
8619 }
8620 
8621 void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8622   ParamIndices[D] = index;
8623 }
8624 
8625 unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8626   ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8627   assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8628          "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8629   return I->second;
8630 }
8631 
8632 APValue *
8633 ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8634                                           bool MayCreate) {
8635   assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8636          "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8637   if (MayCreate) {
8638     APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8639     if (!MTVI)
8640       MTVI = new (*this) APValue;
8641     return MTVI;
8642   }
8643 
8644   return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E);
8645 }
8646 
8647 bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8648   const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8649   if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8650     return false;
8651 
8652   if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8653       !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8654     return false;
8655 
8656   QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8657   CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8658   uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8659   CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8660   unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8661   unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8662   return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8663 }
8664 
8665 namespace {
8666 
8667   /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8668   /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8669   ///
8670   /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8671   /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8672   /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8673   ///
8674   /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8675   class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8676 
8677   public:
8678     /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8679     ///
8680     ///  The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8681     static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8682       ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8683       Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8684       return Visitor.Parents;
8685     }
8686 
8687   private:
8688     typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8689 
8690     ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8691     }
8692 
8693     bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8694       return true;
8695     }
8696     bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8697       return true;
8698     }
8699     // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8700     // are not triggered during data recursion.
8701     bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8702       return false;
8703     }
8704 
8705     template <typename T>
8706     bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
8707       if (!Node)
8708         return true;
8709       if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
8710         // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8711         // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8712         // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8713         // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8714         // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8715         // new matches.
8716         // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8717         // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8718         // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8719         // do not have pointer identity.
8720         auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node];
8721         if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
8722           NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
8723         } else {
8724           if (NodeOrVector.template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8725             auto *Node =
8726                 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
8727             auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node);
8728             NodeOrVector = Vector;
8729             delete Node;
8730           }
8731           assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>());
8732 
8733           auto *Vector =
8734               NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8735           // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8736           // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8737           // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8738           // types.
8739           bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8740                        std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8741                                  ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8742           if (!Found)
8743             Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
8744         }
8745       }
8746       ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8747       bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8748       ParentStack.pop_back();
8749       return Result;
8750     }
8751 
8752     bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8753       return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8754     }
8755 
8756     bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8757       return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8758     }
8759 
8760     ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8761     llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8762 
8763     friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8764   };
8765 
8766 } // end namespace
8767 
8768 ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>
8769 ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8770   assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8771          "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8772          "used in the parent map.");
8773   if (!AllParents) {
8774     // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8775     // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8776     AllParents.reset(
8777         ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8778   }
8779   ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8780   if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8781     return None;
8782   }
8783   if (auto *N = I->second.dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8784     return llvm::makeArrayRef(N, 1);
8785   }
8786   return *I->second.get<ParentVector *>();
8787 }
8788 
8789 bool
8790 ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8791                                 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8792   // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8793   if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8794       || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8795     return false;
8796   if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8797       MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8798     return false;
8799   if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
8800     return false;
8801 
8802   if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8803     return false;
8804 
8805   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8806        IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8807        EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8808        IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8809     const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8810     const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8811     if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8812       return false;
8813     if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8814       return false;
8815   }
8816   return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8817 
8818 }
8819 
8820 // Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8821 // doesn't include ASTContext.h
8822 template
8823 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8824     const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8825 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8826     const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8827         const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);
8828